blob: d4bfd1c65f221b6c8835465ac3934027ff477d43 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreauc94431b2020-12-01 08:15:26 +01007 2020/12/01
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001018.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001038.3. Advanced logging options
1048.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1058.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1068.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1078.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1088.4. Timing events
1098.5. Session state at disconnection
1108.6. Non-printable characters
1118.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1128.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1138.9. Examples of logs
114
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001159. Supported filters
1169.1. Trace
1179.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001189.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001199.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001209.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200121
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012210. FastCGI applications
12310.1. Setup
12410.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12510.1.2. Proxy section
12610.1.3. Example
12710.2. Default parameters
12810.3. Limitations
129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130
1311. Quick reminder about HTTP
132----------------------------
133
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100134When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
136on almost anything found in the contents.
137
138However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
139formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
140correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
141
142
1431.1. The HTTP transaction model
144-------------------------------
145
146The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100147to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100148from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
149connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150will involve a new connection :
151
152 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
153
154In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
155establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
156by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
157length.
158
159Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
160to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
161however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
162response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
163header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
164
165 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
166
167Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
168power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
169but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200170a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
174second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
175page :
176
177 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
178
179This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
180latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
181correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
182the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100183server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100185The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
186time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
187are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
188parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
189carry the stream identifier.
190
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
192connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
193leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
195processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
196waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200197
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200198HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100199 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
200 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100201 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100202 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200203 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100204
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100205
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206
2071.2. HTTP request
208-----------------
209
210First, let's consider this HTTP request :
211
212 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100213 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
215 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
216 3 User-agent: my small browser
217 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
218 5 Accept: image/png
219
220
2211.2.1. The Request line
222-----------------------
223
224Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
225
226 - a METHOD : GET
227 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
228 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
229
230All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
231which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
232followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
233is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
234desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
235the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
236
237The URI itself can have several forms :
238
239 - A "relative URI" :
240
241 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
242
243 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
244 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
245
246 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
247
248 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
249
250 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
251 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
252 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
253 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
254 must accept this form too.
255
256 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
257 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
258 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100259
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200260 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
261 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
262 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
263 other protocols too.
264
265In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
266mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
267on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
268It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
269specific to the language, framework or application in use.
270
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100271HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100272assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100273
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200274
2751.2.2. The request headers
276--------------------------
277
278The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
279beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
280an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
281Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
282values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
283encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
284the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
285define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
286
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100287Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200288their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100289"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200290as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
291normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
292representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
293HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294
295The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
296that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
297is one valid form of empty line.
298
299Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
300headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
301about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
302application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
303
304Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000305 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200306 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
307 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
308 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
309
310
3111.3. HTTP response
312------------------
313
314An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
315messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
316
317 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100318 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200319 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
320 2 Content-length: 350
321 3 Content-Type: text/html
322
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200323As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
324codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
325response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100326continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
327the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
328following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
329sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
330(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
331correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
332such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
333state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
334over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
335if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
336information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200337
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200338
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003391.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200340------------------------
341
342Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
343
344 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
345 - a status code : 200
346 - a reason : OK
347
348The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100349 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
350 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
351 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
352 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
353 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200354
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000355Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100356"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200357found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
358messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
359or "Authentication Required".
360
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362
363 Code When / reason
364 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
365 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
366 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
367 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100368 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
369 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370 400 for an invalid or too large request
371 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
372 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200373 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100374 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100376 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
377 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
379 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
380 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200381 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
383 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
384 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
385
386The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3874.2).
388
389
3901.3.2. The response headers
391---------------------------
392
393Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
394the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
395details.
396
397
3982. Configuring HAProxy
399----------------------
400
4012.1. Configuration file format
402------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200403
404HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
405
406 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100407 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
408 - the running process' environment, in case some environment variables are
409 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200410
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100411The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
412a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100413
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100414 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
415
416 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
417
418 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
419 tab characters
420
421 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
422 keyword sequences listed in this document
423
424 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
425 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
426 parts of the configuration, or expressions
427
428 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
429 are supported
430
431 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
432 section
433
434This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
435generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
436figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
437
438First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
439the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
440a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
441word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
442follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
443the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
444the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
445the parts that need to be addressed.
446
447A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
448requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
449extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
450the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
451section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
452section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
453not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
454
455A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
456each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
457a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
458start a new one.
459
460Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
461that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
462applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
463"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
464processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
465ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
466which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
467In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
468of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
469identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
470such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4712, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
472
473 listen foo
474 bind :80
475
476 listen bar
477 bind :81
478
479Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
480spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
481of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
482following configurations are strictly equivalent:
483
484 global#this is the global section
485 daemon#daemonize
486 frontend foo
487 mode http # or tcp
488
489and:
490
491 global
492 daemon
493
494 # this is the public web frontend
495 frontend foo
496 mode http
497
498The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
499new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
500other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
501section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
502section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
503at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
504
505Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
506are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
507editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
508support automatic indent.
509
510In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
511positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
512modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
513anymore, and is not recommended.
514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200515
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005162.2. Quoting and escaping
517-------------------------
518
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100519In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
520that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
521possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
522in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
523('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200524
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100525This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
526very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
527the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
528also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
529delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
530word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
531remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
534(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
535
536Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
537backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200538
539 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
540 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
541 \\ to use a backslash
542 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
543 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
544
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100545In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
546C-language representation:
547
548 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
549 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
550 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
551 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
552
553Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
554or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
555of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200556
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100557 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200558 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
559 # hash as a comment start
560
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100561Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
562evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
563dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
564backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200565
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100566Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
567character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
568is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200569
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100570As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
571entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
572name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
573represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
574hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200575
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100576 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
577 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
578 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
579 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
580 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
581 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
582 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
583 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
584 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
585 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
586 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200587
588 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100589 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200590 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
591 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
592 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
593 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
594 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
595
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100596There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
597necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
598by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
599they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
600escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
601characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
602case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
603if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
604own quotes.
605
606The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
607quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
608not always obvious is that the delimitors used inside must first be escaped or
609quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
610
611Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
612arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
613
614 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
615 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
616
617Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
618"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
619cannot write:
620
621 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
622
623because we would like the string to cut like this:
624
625 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
626 |---------|----|-|
627 arg1 _/ / /
628 arg2 __________/ /
629 arg3 ______________/
630
631but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
632parenthesis then garbage:
633
634 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
635 |--------|--------|
636 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
637 trailing garbage _________/
638
639The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
640quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
641processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
642this word:
643
644 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
645 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
646 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
647
648So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
649still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
650the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
651the second level:
652
653 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
654 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
655 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
656 |---------||----|-|
657 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
658 arg2=blah ___________/ /
659 arg3=g _______________/
660
661Another approch consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
662double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
663
664 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
665 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
666 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
667 |---------||----|-|
668 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
669 arg2 ___________/ /
670 arg3 _______________/
671
672When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
673appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
674string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
675thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
676
677 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
678 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
679 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
680 |-------------| |-----||-|
681 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
682 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
683 arg3 ______________________/
684
685Remember that backslahes are not escape characters withing single quotes and
686that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
687quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
688single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
689level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
690
691When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
692double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
693and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
694a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
695a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
696the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
697regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
698around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
699more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200700
701
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007022.3. Environment variables
703--------------------------
704
705HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
706interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
707configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
708optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
709shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200710underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
711list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
712arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
713before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200714
715 Example:
716
717 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
718
719 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
720
721 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
722
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200723Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
724file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200725
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200726* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
727 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
728
729* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
730 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
731 directory.
732
733* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
734
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500735* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200736 processes, separated by semicolons.
737
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500738* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200739 CLI, separated by semicolons.
740
741See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200742
7432.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200744----------------
745
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100746Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100747values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
748otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
749numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
750for every keyword. Supported units are :
751
752 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
753 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
754 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
755 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
756 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
757 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
758
759
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00007602.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200761-------------
762
763 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
764 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
765 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
766 global
767 daemon
768 maxconn 256
769
770 defaults
771 mode http
772 timeout connect 5000ms
773 timeout client 50000ms
774 timeout server 50000ms
775
776 frontend http-in
777 bind *:80
778 default_backend servers
779
780 backend servers
781 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
782
783
784 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
785 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
786 global
787 daemon
788 maxconn 256
789
790 defaults
791 mode http
792 timeout connect 5000ms
793 timeout client 50000ms
794 timeout server 50000ms
795
796 listen http-in
797 bind *:80
798 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
799
800
801Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
802
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100803 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200804
805
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008063. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200807--------------------
808
809Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
810are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
811of them have command-line equivalents.
812
813The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
814
815 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200816 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200817 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200818 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200819 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200820 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200821 - description
822 - deviceatlas-json-file
823 - deviceatlas-log-level
824 - deviceatlas-separator
825 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900826 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200827 - gid
828 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100829 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200830 - h1-case-adjust
831 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100832 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100833 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100834 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200835 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200836 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200837 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100838 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200839 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +0100840 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100841 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200842 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200843 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200844 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200845 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200846 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200847 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100848 - presetenv
849 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200850 - uid
851 - ulimit-n
852 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200853 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100854 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200855 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200856 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200857 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200858 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200859 - ssl-default-bind-options
860 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200861 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200862 - ssl-default-server-options
863 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100864 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200865 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100866 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100867 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100868 - 51degrees-data-file
869 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200870 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200871 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200872 - wurfl-data-file
873 - wurfl-information-list
874 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200875 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100876 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100877
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200878 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100879 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200880 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200881 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200882 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100883 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100884 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100885 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200886 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200887 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200888 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200889 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200890 - noepoll
891 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000892 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200893 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100894 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300895 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000896 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100897 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200898 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200899 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200900 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000901 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000902 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200903 - tune.buffers.limit
904 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200905 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200906 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100907 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200908 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200909 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200910 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200911 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100912 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200913 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200914 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200915 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100916 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100917 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100918 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100919 - tune.lua.session-timeout
920 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200921 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100922 - tune.maxaccept
923 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200924 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200925 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200926 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200927 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
928 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100929 - tune.rcvbuf.client
930 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100931 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200932 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +0200933 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100934 - tune.sndbuf.client
935 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100936 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +0200937 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100938 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200939 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100940 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200941 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200942 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100943 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200944 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100945 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200946 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
947 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
948 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100949 - tune.zlib.memlevel
950 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100951
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200952 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200953 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200954 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200955
956
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009573.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200958------------------------------------
959
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200960ca-base <dir>
961 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100962 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
963 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
964 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200965
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200966chroot <jail dir>
967 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
968 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
969 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
970 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
971 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100972 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100973
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100974cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
975 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
976 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
977 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
978 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
979 set. These sets have the format
980
981 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
982
983 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100984 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100985 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
986 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100987 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
988 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100989 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100990 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100991 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100992 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100993 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
994 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
995 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
996 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100997
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100998 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
999 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1000 on the machine's word size.
1001
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001002 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001003 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1004 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1005 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1006 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1007 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1008 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001009
1010 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001011 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1012
1013 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1014 # first 4 CPUs
1015
1016 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1017 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1018 # word size.
1019
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001020 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001021 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001022 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1023 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1024 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1025
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001026 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1027 # and so on.
1028 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1029 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1030 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1031
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001032 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001033 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1034 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1035 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1036
1037 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1038 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1039 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1040
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001041 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1042 # and a thread range.
1043 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1044 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1045 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1046
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001047crt-base <dir>
1048 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001049 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1050 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001051
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001052daemon
1053 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1054 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001055 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1056 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001057
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001058deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1059 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001060 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001061
1062deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001063 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001064 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1065
1066deviceatlas-separator <char>
1067 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1068 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1069
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001070deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001071 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1072 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1073 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001074
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001075external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001076 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1077 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001078 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1079 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1080 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1081 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1082 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001083
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001084gid <number>
1085 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
1086 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1087 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001088 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
1089 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001090 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001091
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001092group <group name>
1093 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1094 See also "gid" and "user".
1095
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001096hard-stop-after <time>
1097 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1098
1099 Arguments :
1100 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1101 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1102 SIGUSR1 signal.
1103
1104 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1105 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1106 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1107
1108 Example:
1109 global
1110 hard-stop-after 30s
1111
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001112h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1113 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1114 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1115 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1116 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001117 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001118 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1119 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1120 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1121 specified in a proxy.
1122
1123 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1124 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1125 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1126 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1127 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1128 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1129 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1130
1131 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1132 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1133 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1134 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1135 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1136
1137 Example:
1138 global
1139 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1140
1141 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1142 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1143
1144h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1145 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1146 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1147 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1148 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1149 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1150 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1151 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1152 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1153
1154 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1155 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1156 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1157
1158 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1159 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1160
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001161insecure-fork-wanted
1162 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
1163 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1164 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1165 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1166 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1167 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1168 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1169 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
1170 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
1171 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1172 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1173 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1174 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1175 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1176 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1177 disable it.
1178
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001179insecure-setuid-wanted
1180 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1181 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1182 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1183 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
1184 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
1185 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
1186 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
1187 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1188 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
1189 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
1190 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1191 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1192 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1193 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1194
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001195issuers-chain-path <dir>
1196 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1197 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1198 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
1199 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
1200 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1201 "issuers-chain-path".
1202 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1203 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1204 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1205 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1206 will share the chain in memory.
1207
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001208localpeer <name>
1209 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1210 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1211 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1212 the configuration parsing.
1213
1214 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1215 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1216
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001217log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
1218 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001219 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001220 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001221 configured with "log global".
1222
1223 <address> can be one of:
1224
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001225 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001226 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1227 port).
1228
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001229 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1230 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1231 port).
1232
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001233 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001234 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1235 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001236 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001237
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001238 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1239 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1240 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1241 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1242 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1243 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1244 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1245 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1246 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1247 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1248 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1249 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1250 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1251 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001252 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1253 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001254
1255 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1256 "fd@2", see above.
1257
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001258 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1259 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1260 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1261 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1262 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1263
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001264 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1265 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001266
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001267 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1268 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1269 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1270 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1271 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1272 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1273 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1274 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1275 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1276 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001277 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1278 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001279
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001280 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1281 one of the following :
1282
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001283 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1284 field is stripped. This is the default.
1285 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1286 rfc3164.
1287
1288 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001289 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1290
1291 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1292 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1293
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001294 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1295 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1296 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1297 designed to be used with a local log server.
1298
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001299 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1300 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1301 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1302 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1303 logger consumes.
1304
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001305 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1306 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1307 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1308 used with a local log server.
1309
1310 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1311 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1312 designed to be used with a local log server.
1313
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001314 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1315 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1316 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1317 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1318
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001319 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1320 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1321 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1322 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1323 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1324
1325 <sample_size>
1326 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1327 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1328 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1329 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1330 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1331
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001332 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001333
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001334 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1335 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1336 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1337
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001338 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1339 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1340 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1341 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001342
1343 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001344 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1345 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1346 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1347 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1348 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1349 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001350
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001351 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001352
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001353log-send-hostname [<string>]
1354 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1355 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1356 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1357 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1358 the logs.
1359
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001360log-tag <string>
1361 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1362 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1363 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001364 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001365
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001366lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001367 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1368 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1369 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1370 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1371 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1372 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001373 used multiple times.
1374
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001375lua-load-per-thread <file>
1376 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1377 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1378 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1379 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1380 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1381 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1382 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1383 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1384 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1385 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1386 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1387 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1388 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1389 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1390 times.
1391
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001392lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1393 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1394 variable.
1395 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1396 to "path".
1397
1398 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1399 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1400 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1401 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1402 will be checked earlier.
1403
1404 As an example by specifying the following path:
1405
1406 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1407 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1408
1409 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1410 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1411 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1412 paths if that does not exist either.
1413
1414 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1415 documentation.
1416
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001417master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001418 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1419 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1420 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001421 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001422 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1423 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001424 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1425 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1426 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1427 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1428 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001429
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001430 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001431
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001432mworker-max-reloads <number>
1433 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001434 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001435 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1436 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1437 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1438
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001439nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001440 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1441 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1442 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001443 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1444 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001445 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1446 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1447 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001448
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001449nbthread <number>
1450 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001451 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1452 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1453 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1454 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1455 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001456 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1457 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1458 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1459 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1460 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1461 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1462 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001463
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001464pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001465 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1466 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1467 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1468 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001469
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001470pp2-never-send-local
1471 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1472 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1473 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1474 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1475 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1476 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1477 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1478 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1479 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1480 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1481 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1482
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001483presetenv <name> <value>
1484 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1485 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1486 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1487 and "unsetenv".
1488
1489resetenv [<name> ...]
1490 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1491 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1492 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1493 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1494 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1495 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1496 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1497 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1498
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001499stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001500 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1501 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1502 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1503 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1504 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1505 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001506 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001507 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1508 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1509 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1510 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001511
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001512server-state-base <directory>
1513 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001514 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1515 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001516
1517server-state-file <file>
1518 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1519 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1520 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1521 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1522 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1523 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1524 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1525 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001526 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1527 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001528
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001529setenv <name> <value>
1530 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1531 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1532 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1533 and "unsetenv".
1534
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001535set-dumpable
1536 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001537 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1538 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1539 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1540 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1541 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1542 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1543 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1544 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1545 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1546 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1547 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1548 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1549 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1550 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1551 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1552 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1553 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001554
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001555ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1556 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1557 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001558 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001559 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001560 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1561 information and recommendations see e.g.
1562 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1563 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1564 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1565 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001566
1567ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1568 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1569 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1570 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1571 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1572 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001573 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1574 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1575 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001576 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001577
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001578ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1579 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1580 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1581 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1582 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1583 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1584
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001585ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1586 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1587 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1588 keyword to see available options.
1589
1590 Example:
1591 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001592 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001593
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001594ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1595 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1596 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001597 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001598 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001599 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1600 information and recommendations see e.g.
1601 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1602 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1603 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1604 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1605 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001606
1607ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1608 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1609 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1610 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1611 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1612 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001613 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1614 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1615 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1616 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001617
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001618ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1619 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1620 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1621 keyword to see available options.
1622
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001623ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1624 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1625 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1626 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001627 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001628 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001629 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1630 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1631 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1632 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001633 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1634 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1635 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1636
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001637ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1638 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1639 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001640 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001641 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001642 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1643
1644 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001645
1646 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1647 and won't try to remove them.
1648
1649 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1650
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001651ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001652 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001653 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1654 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001655
1656 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1657 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1658 optimize the startup time.
1659
1660 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1661 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1662 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1663
1664 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001665 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001666
1667 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001668 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1669
1670 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1671 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1672 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1673 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1674 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1675 bind configuration..
1676
1677 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1678 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1679 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1680 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1681 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1682 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1683 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1684 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1685
1686 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1687
1688 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1689 a cert bundle.
1690
1691 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1692 separately in several "crt".
1693
1694 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1695 since files are loading separately.
1696
1697 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1698 required to commit them.
1699
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001700 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001701 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001702
1703 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1704
1705 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1706
1707 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1708 not provided in the PEM file.
1709
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001710 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1711 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1712
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001713 The default behavior is "all".
1714
1715 Example:
1716 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1717 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1718 ssl-load-extra-files none
1719
1720 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1721
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001722ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1723 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1724 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1725 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1726
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001727ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001728 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001729 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1730 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1731 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1732 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1733 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1734 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001735 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001736
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001737stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1738 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1739 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1740 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001741 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001742 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001743
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001744 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1745 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1746 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001747
1748stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1749 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1750 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001751 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001752
1753stats maxconn <connections>
1754 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1755 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1756
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001757uid <number>
1758 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1759 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1760 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1761 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1762
1763ulimit-n <number>
1764 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1765 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1766 option.
1767
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001768unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1769 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1770
1771 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1772 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1773 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1774 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1775 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1776 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1777 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1778 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1779 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1780 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1781
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001782unsetenv [<name> ...]
1783 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1784 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1785 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1786 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1787 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1788 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1789 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1790
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001791user <user name>
1792 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1793 See also "uid" and "group".
1794
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001795node <name>
1796 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1797
1798 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1799 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1800 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1801 traffic.
1802
1803description <text>
1804 Add a text that describes the instance.
1805
1806 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1807 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1808 "<" and ">" characters.
1809
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100181051degrees-data-file <file path>
1811 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001812 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001813
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001814 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001815 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1816
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000181751degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001818 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1819 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1820 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1821
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001822 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001823 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1824
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200182551degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001826 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1827 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1828
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001829 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1830 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1831
183251degrees-cache-size <number>
1833 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1834 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1835 By default, this cache is disabled.
1836
1837 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001838 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1839
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001840wurfl-data-file <file path>
1841 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1842 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1843
1844 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1845 with USE_WURFL=1.
1846
1847wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1848 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1849 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1850 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1851
1852 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1853
1854 Valid WURFL properties are:
1855 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1856
1857 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1858 device.
1859
1860 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1861 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1862
1863 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1864 particular web request.
1865
1866 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1867 used Libwurfl API version.
1868
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001869 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1870 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1871
1872 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1873 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1874
1875 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1876
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001877 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1878 with USE_WURFL=1.
1879
1880wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1881 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1882 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1883
1884 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1885 with USE_WURFL=1.
1886
1887wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1888 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1889 thus before the chroot.
1890
1891 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1892 with USE_WURFL=1.
1893
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001894wurfl-cache-size <size>
1895 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1896 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001897 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001898 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001899
1900 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1901 with USE_WURFL=1.
1902
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001903strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01001904 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
1905 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
1906 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
1907 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
1908 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001909
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019103.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001911-----------------------
1912
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001913busy-polling
1914 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1915 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1916 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1917 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1918 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1919 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1920 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1921 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1922 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1923 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1924 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1925 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1926 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1927 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1928 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1929 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1930 "poll" pollers.
1931
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001932 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1933 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1934 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1935
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001936max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1937 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1938 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1939 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1940 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1941 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1942 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1943 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1944 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1945
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001946maxconn <number>
1947 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1948 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1949 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001950 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1951 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1952 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1953 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001954 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1955 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1956 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1957 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1958 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1959 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001960
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001961maxconnrate <number>
1962 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1963 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1964 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1965 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1966 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1967 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1968 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1969 fairness.
1970
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001971maxcomprate <number>
1972 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001973 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001974 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1975 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1976 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001977 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001978 default value.
1979
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001980maxcompcpuusage <number>
1981 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1982 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1983 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1984 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1985 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1986 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1987 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1988 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1989
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001990maxpipes <number>
1991 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1992 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1993 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1994 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1995 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1996 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1997
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001998maxsessrate <number>
1999 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2000 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2001 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2002 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2003 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2004 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2005 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2006 fairness.
2007
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002008maxsslconn <number>
2009 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2010 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2011 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2012 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2013 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2014 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2015 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002016 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2017 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2018 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2019 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
2020 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
2021 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2022 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002023
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002024maxsslrate <number>
2025 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2026 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2027 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2028 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2029 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2030 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2031 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2032 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2033 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2034 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2035
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002036maxzlibmem <number>
2037 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2038 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2039 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002040 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2041 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2042 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2043
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002044noepoll
2045 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2046 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002047 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002048
2049nokqueue
2050 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2051 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2052 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2053
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002054noevports
2055 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2056 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2057 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2058 also "nopoll".
2059
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002060nopoll
2061 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2062 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002063 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002064 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2065 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002066
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002067nosplice
2068 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002069 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002070 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002071 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002072 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2073 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2074 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2075 "option splice-response".
2076
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002077nogetaddrinfo
2078 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2079 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2080
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002081noreuseport
2082 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2083 command line argument "-dR".
2084
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002085profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2086 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2087 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2088 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2089 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002090 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002091 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2092 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2093 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2094 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2095
2096 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2097 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2098 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2099 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2100 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002101 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2102 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2103 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2104 CLI.
2105
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002106spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002107 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2108 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2109 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2110 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2111 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2112 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002113
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002114ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002115 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002116 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002117 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
2118 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
2119 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2120 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2121 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002122 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2123 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002124 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2125 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2126 openssl configuration file uses:
2127 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2128
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002129ssl-mode-async
2130 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002131 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002132 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2133 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
2134 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002135 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002136 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002137
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002138tune.buffers.limit <number>
2139 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2140 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2141 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2142 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2143 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002144 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002145 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2146 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2147 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2148 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2149 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2150 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2151 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2152 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
2153 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
2154
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002155tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2156 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2157 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2158 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
2159 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
2160
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002161tune.bufsize <number>
2162 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2163 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2164 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2165 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2166 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2167 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2168 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002169 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2170 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
2171 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002172 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002173 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
2174 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2175 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002176
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002177tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2178 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002179
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002180tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2181 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2182 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2183 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2184 this value. The default value is 1.
2185
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002186tune.fail-alloc
2187 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2188 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2189 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2190 gracefully.
2191
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002192tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2193 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2194 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2195 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2196 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2197 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2198
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002199tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2200 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2201 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2202 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2203 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2204 change it.
2205
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002206tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2207 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002208 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
2209 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002210 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2211 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2212 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2213 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2214 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2215
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002216tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2217 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2218 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2219 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2220 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2221 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
2222 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
2223 recommended not to change this value.
2224
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002225tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
2226 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
2227 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
2228 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
2229 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2230 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2231 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2232 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2233
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002234tune.http.cookielen <number>
2235 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2236 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2237 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2238 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2239 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2240 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2241 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2242 to change this value.
2243
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002244tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002245 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2246 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002247 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002248 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002249 configuration directives too.
2250 The default value is 1024.
2251
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002252tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2253 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2254 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2255 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2256 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2257 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2258 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002259 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2260 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2261 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002262
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002263tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2264 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2265 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2266 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2267 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2268 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2269 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
2270 this option to "off". The default is on.
2271
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002272tune.idletimer <timeout>
2273 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2274 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2275 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2276 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2277 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2278 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002279 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002280 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002281 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2282
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002283tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2284 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2285 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2286 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2287 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2288 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2289 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2290 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2291 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2292 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2293
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002294tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2295 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002296 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002297 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2298 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002299 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002300 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2301 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2302
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002303tune.lua.maxmem
2304 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2305 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2306 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2307 memory.
2308
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002309tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2310 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002311 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2312 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002313 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002314
2315tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2316 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2317 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2318 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2319 check servers.
2320
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002321tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2322 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2323 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2324 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002325 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002326
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002327tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002328 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2329 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
2330 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
2331 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
2332 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
2333 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
2334 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
2335 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
2336 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
2337 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002338
2339tune.maxpollevents <number>
2340 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2341 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2342 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2343 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2344 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2345
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002346tune.maxrewrite <number>
2347 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2348 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2349 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2350 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2351 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2352 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2353 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2354 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2355 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2356 bufsize.
2357
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002358tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2359 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2360 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2361 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2362 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2363 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2364 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2365 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2366 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2367 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002368 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2369 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002370 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2371 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2372 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2373 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2374 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2375 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2376 setting this parameter to 0.
2377
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002378tune.pipesize <number>
2379 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2380 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2381 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2382 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2383 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2384 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2385
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002386tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2387 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2388 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2389 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2390 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2391 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2392 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002393 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002394
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002395tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2396 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2397 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2398 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2399 default is 20.
2400
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002401tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2402tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2403 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2404 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2405 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002406 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002407 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002408 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2409 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2410
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002411tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002412 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002413 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2414 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2415 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2416 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2417
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002418tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002419 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002420 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002421 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead. When
2422 experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2423 tune.sched.low-latency to limit the maximum latency to the lowest possible.
2424
2425tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2426 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2427 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2428 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2429 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2430 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2431 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2432 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2433 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2434 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002435
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002436tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2437tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2438 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2439 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2440 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002441 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002442 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002443 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2444 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2445 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2446 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2447 notifying haproxy again.
2448
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002449tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002450 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2451 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2452 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002453 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002454 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002455 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002456 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2457 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2458 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002459 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2460 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002461
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002462tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002463 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002464 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2465 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2466 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2467 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2468 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2469
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002470tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2471 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2472 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2473 performances. This is disabled by default.
2474
2475 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2476 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2477
2478 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2479
2480 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2481
2482 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2483
2484 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2485 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2486 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2487
2488 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2489 converted.
2490
2491 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2492 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2493 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2494 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2495 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2496 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2497 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002498 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2499 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002500
2501 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2502
2503 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2504 only need this line:
2505
2506 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2507
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002508tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2509 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002510 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002511 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2512 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2513 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2514 being used for too long.
2515
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002516tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2517 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2518 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2519 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2520 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2521 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2522 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2523 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2524 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2525 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2526 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002527 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002528 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002529
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002530tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2531 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2532 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2533 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2534 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002535 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002536 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2537 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002538 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2539 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002540
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002541tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2542 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2543 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2544 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2545 1000 entries.
2546
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002547tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2548 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2549 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2550 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2551
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002552tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002553tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002554tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2555tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2556tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002557 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2558 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2559 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2560 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2561 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2562 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2563 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2564 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002565
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002566 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2567 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2568 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2569 all available space is consumed.
2570 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2571 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2572 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002573
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002574tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2575 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002576 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002577 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002578 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002579 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2580
2581tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2582 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2583 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002584 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2585 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002586
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025873.3. Debugging
2588--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002589
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002590quiet
2591 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2592 line argument "-q".
2593
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002594zero-warning
2595 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2596 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2597 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2598 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2599 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2600 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2601
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002602
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010026033.4. Userlists
2604--------------
2605It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2606http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2607it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2608
2609userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002610 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002611 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2612
2613group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002614 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002615 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2616 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2617
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002618user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2619 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002620 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2621 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002622 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2623 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2624 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2625 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002626
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002627 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2628 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2629 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2630 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2631 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2632 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2633 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2634 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2635 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002636
2637 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002638 userlist L1
2639 group G1 users tiger,scott
2640 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002641
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002642 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2643 user scott insecure-password elgato
2644 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002645
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002646 userlist L2
2647 group G1
2648 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002649
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002650 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2651 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2652 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002653
2654 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002655
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002656
26573.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002658----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002659It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2660several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2661instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2662values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2663automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2664In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2665using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2666tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2667reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2668Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2669that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2670each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002671
2672peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002673 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002674 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2675
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002676bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2677 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2678 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2679
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002680disabled
2681 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2682 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2683 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2684
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002685default-bind [param*]
2686 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2687
2688default-server [param*]
2689 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2690
2691 Arguments:
2692 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2693 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2694 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2695 details.
2696
2697
2698 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2699
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002700enable
2701 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2702
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002703log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2704 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2705 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2706 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2707 more details.
2708
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002709peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002710 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2711 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002712 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2713 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2714 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2715 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2716 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002717
2718 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2719 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2720
2721 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002722 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2723 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2724 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002725
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002726 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2727 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002728
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002729 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2730 "server" keyword explanation below).
2731
2732server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002733 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002734 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2735 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2736 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2737 of this "peers" section).
2738 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2739
2740
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002741 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002742 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002743 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002744 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2745 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2746 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002747
2748 backend mybackend
2749 mode tcp
2750 balance roundrobin
2751 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2752 stick on src
2753
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002754 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2755 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002756
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002757 Example:
2758 peers mypeers
2759 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2760 default-server ssl verify none
2761 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2762 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002763
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002764
2765table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2766 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2767
2768 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2769 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002770 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002771 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2772 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2773 "stick-table" keyword).
2774
2775 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2776 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2777 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2778 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2779 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2780 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2781 of the stick-table name as follows:
2782
2783 peers mypeers
2784 peer A ...
2785 peer B ...
2786 table t1 ...
2787
2788 frontend fe1
2789 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2790
2791 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2792 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2793
2794 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2795 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2796 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2797 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2798 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2799 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2800 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2801
2802 peers mypeers
2803 peer A ...
2804 peer B ...
2805 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2806
2807 backend t1
2808 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2809
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002810 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002811 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2812 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2813
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090028143.6. Mailers
2815------------
2816It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2817If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2818in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2819
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002820mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002821 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2822 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2823
2824mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2825 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2826
2827 Example:
2828 mailers mymailers
2829 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2830 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2831
2832 backend mybackend
2833 mode tcp
2834 balance roundrobin
2835
2836 email-alert mailers mymailers
2837 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2838 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2839
2840 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2841 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2842
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002843timeout mail <time>
2844 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2845 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2846 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2847 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2848
2849 Example:
2850 mailers mymailers
2851 timeout mail 20s
2852 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002853
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020028543.7. Programs
2855-------------
2856In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2857master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2858managed the same way as the workers.
2859
2860During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2861sequence as a worker:
2862
2863 - the master is re-executed
2864 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2865 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2866 instance of the program
2867
2868During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2869
2870program <name>
2871 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2872 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2873 the management guide).
2874
2875command <command> [arguments*]
2876 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2877 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2878 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2879 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2880
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002881user <user name>
2882 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2883 See also "group".
2884
2885group <group name>
2886 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2887 See also "user".
2888
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002889option start-on-reload
2890no option start-on-reload
2891 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2892 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2893 program section.
2894
2895
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010028963.8. HTTP-errors
2897----------------
2898
2899It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2900imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2901several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2902
2903http-errors <name>
2904 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2905 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2906
2907errorfile <code> <file>
2908 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2909
2910 Arguments :
2911 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002912 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
2913 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002914
2915 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2916 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2917 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2918 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2919 before any chroot is performed.
2920
2921 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2922
2923 Example:
2924 http-errors website-1
2925 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2926 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2927 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2928
2929 http-errors website-2
2930 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2931 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2932 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2933
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020029343.9. Rings
2935----------
2936
2937It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
2938servers or traces.
2939
2940ring <ringname>
2941 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
2942
2943description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002944 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002945 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
2946
2947format <format>
2948 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
2949
2950 Arguments:
2951 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
2952 one of the following :
2953
2954 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
2955 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
2956 designed to be used with a local log server.
2957
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01002958 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
2959 field is stripped. This is the default.
2960 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
2961 rfc3164.
2962
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002963 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
2964 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2965 used in containers or during development, where the severity
2966 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
2967 is the default.
2968
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01002969 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002970 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
2971
2972 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
2973 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
2974
2975 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2976 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
2977 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
2978 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
2979 logger consumes.
2980
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02002981 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
2982 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
2983 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
2984 with a local log server.
2985
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002986 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2987 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
2988 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2989 used with a local log server.
2990
2991maxlen <length>
2992 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
2993 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
2994 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
2995
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002996server <name> <address> [param*]
2997 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
2998 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
2999 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3000 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3001 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3002 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3003 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3004 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3005 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003006 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3007 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003008
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003009size <size>
3010 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3011 set to BUFSIZE.
3012
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003013timeout connect <timeout>
3014 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3015
3016 Arguments :
3017 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3018 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3019 as explained at the top of this document.
3020
3021timeout server <timeout>
3022 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3023
3024 Arguments :
3025 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3026 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3027 as explained at the top of this document.
3028
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003029 Example:
3030 global
3031 log ring@myring local7
3032
3033 ring myring
3034 description "My local buffer"
3035 format rfc3164
3036 maxlen 1200
3037 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003038 timeout connect 5s
3039 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003040 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003041
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020030423.10. Log forwarding
3043-------------------
3044
3045It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
3046haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
3047
3048log-forward <name>
3049 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3050
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003051backlog <conns>
3052 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3053 on connections accept.
3054
3055bind <addr> [param*]
3056 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003057 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3058 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3059 syslog protocol over TCP.
3060 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003061 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3062
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003063dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003064 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3065 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3066 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3067 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003068 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003069
3070log global
3071log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
3072 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3073 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3074 documentation.
3075 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
3076 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3077 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3078 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
3079 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
3080
3081 Example:
3082 global
3083 log stderr format iso local7
3084
3085 ring myring
3086 description "My local buffer"
3087 format rfc5424
3088 maxlen 1200
3089 size 32764
3090 timeout connect 5s
3091 timeout server 10s
3092 # syslog tcp server
3093 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3094
3095 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003096 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3097 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003098 # all messages on stderr
3099 log global
3100 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3101 log ring@myring local0
3102 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3103 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3104 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3105 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3106 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003107
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003108maxconn <conns>
3109 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3110 10 is the default.
3111
3112timeout client <timeout>
3113 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3114
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020031154. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003116----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003117
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003118Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02003119 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003120 - frontend <name>
3121 - backend <name>
3122 - listen <name>
3123
3124A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
3125its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
3126section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003127section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003128
3129A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3130connections.
3131
3132A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3133to forward incoming connections.
3134
3135A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3136parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3137
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003138All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3139'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3140case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3141
3142Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3143logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3144proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3145However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3146name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3147
3148Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3149and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003150bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003151protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3152modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3153arbitrary criteria.
3154
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003155In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3156a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003157the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003158
3159 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3160 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3161 between responses and new requests.
3162
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003163 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3164 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3165 client-facing connection remains open.
3166
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003167 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3168 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003169
3170The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3171frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3172following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003173weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003174
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003175 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003176
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003177 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3178 ----+-----+-----+----
3179 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3180 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003181 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3182 ----+-----+-----+----
3183 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003184
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003185
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003186
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020031874.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3188--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003189
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003190The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3191limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3192they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3193limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003194marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003195option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003196and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3197with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3198specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003199
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003200
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003201 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3202------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3203acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003204backlog X X X -
3205balance X - X X
3206bind - X X -
3207bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003208capture cookie - X X -
3209capture request header - X X -
3210capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003211clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3212clitcpka-idle X X X -
3213clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003214compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003215cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003216declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003217default-server X - X X
3218default_backend X X X -
3219description - X X X
3220disabled X X X X
3221dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003222email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003223email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003224email-alert mailers X X X X
3225email-alert myhostname X X X X
3226email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003227enabled X X X X
3228errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003229errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003230errorloc X X X X
3231errorloc302 X X X X
3232-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3233errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003234force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003235filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003236fullconn X - X X
3237grace X X X X
3238hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003239http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003240http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003241http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003242http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003243http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003244http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003245http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003246http-check set-var X - X X
3247http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003248http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003249http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003250http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003251http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003252http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003253id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003254ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003255load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003256log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003257log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003258log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003259log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003260max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003261maxconn X X X -
3262mode X X X X
3263monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003264monitor-uri X X X -
3265option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3266option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3267option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3268option allbackups (*) X - X X
3269option checkcache (*) X - X X
3270option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3271option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003272option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003273option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3274option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003275-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3276option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003277option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3278option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003279option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003280option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003281option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003282option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003283option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003284option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3285option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3286option httpchk X - X X
3287option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003288option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003289option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003290option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003291option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003292option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003293option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3294option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3295option logasap (*) X X X -
3296option mysql-check X - X X
3297option nolinger (*) X X X X
3298option originalto X X X X
3299option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003300option pgsql-check X - X X
3301option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003302option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003303option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003304option smtpchk X - X X
3305option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3306option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3307option splice-request (*) X X X X
3308option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003309option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003310option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3311option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3312-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003313option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003314option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3315option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3316option tcpka X X X X
3317option tcplog X X X X
3318option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003319external-check command X - X X
3320external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003321persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3322rate-limit sessions X X X -
3323redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003324-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003325retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003326retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003327server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003328server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003329server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003330source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003331srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3332srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3333srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003334stats admin - X X X
3335stats auth X X X X
3336stats enable X X X X
3337stats hide-version X X X X
3338stats http-request - X X X
3339stats realm X X X X
3340stats refresh X X X X
3341stats scope X X X X
3342stats show-desc X X X X
3343stats show-legends X X X X
3344stats show-node X X X X
3345stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003346-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3347stick match - - X X
3348stick on - - X X
3349stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003350stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003351stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003352tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003353tcp-check connect X - X X
3354tcp-check expect X - X X
3355tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003356tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003357tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003358tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003359tcp-check set-var X - X X
3360tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003361tcp-request connection - X X -
3362tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003363tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003364tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003365tcp-response content - - X X
3366tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003367timeout check X - X X
3368timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003369timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003370timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003371timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3372timeout http-request X X X X
3373timeout queue X - X X
3374timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003375timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003376timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003377timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003378transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003379unique-id-format X X X -
3380unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003381use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003382use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003383use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003384------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3385 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003386
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003387
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033884.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3389---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003390
3391This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3392
3393
3394acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3395 Declare or complete an access list.
3396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3397 no | yes | yes | yes
3398 Example:
3399 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3400 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3401 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3402
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003403 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003404
3405
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003406backlog <conns>
3407 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3409 yes | yes | yes | no
3410 Arguments :
3411 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3412 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003413 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003414
3415 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3416 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3417 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3418 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3419 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3420 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3421 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3422 backlog parameter.
3423
3424 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3425 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3426 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3427
3428 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3429
3430
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003431balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003432balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003433 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3435 yes | no | yes | yes
3436 Arguments :
3437 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3438 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3439 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3440 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3441
3442 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3443 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3444 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3445 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003446 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003447 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003448 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3449 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3450 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3451 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3452 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3453 it, so that you don't worry.
3454
3455 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3456 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3457 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3458 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3459 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3460 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3461 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3462 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003463
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003464 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3465 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3466 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3467 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3468 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3469 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3470 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003471 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3472 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3473 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003474
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003475 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003476 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003477 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3478 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003479 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003480 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3481 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3482 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3483 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3484 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003485 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3486 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3487 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3488 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3489 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3490 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003491
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003492 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3493 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3494 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3495 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3496 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3497 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3498 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3499 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003500 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003501 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003502 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3503 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3504 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003505
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003506 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3507 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3508 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3509 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3510 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3511 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3512 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3513 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3514 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3515 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3516 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3517 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003518
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003519 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003520 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3521 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3522 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3523 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3524 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3525 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3526 URIs start with a leading "/".
3527
3528 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3529 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3530 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3531 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3532
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003533 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3534 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3535 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3536 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3537
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003538 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003539 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3540
3541 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003542 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3543 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003544 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3545 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3546 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3547 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003548 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003549 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3550 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003551
3552 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3553 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3554 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3555 server will receive the request.
3556
3557 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3558 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3559 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3560 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3561 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003562 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3563 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3564 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003565
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003566 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3567 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3568 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3569 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3570 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003571
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003572 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003573 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3574 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3575 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3576
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003577 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3578 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3579 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3580
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003581 random
3582 random(<draws>)
3583 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003584 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3585 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3586 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3587 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003588 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3589 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3590 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3591 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3592 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3593 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3594 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3595 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3596 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3597 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3598 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3599 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3600 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3601 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3602 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3603 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3604 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3605 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3606 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3607 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003608
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003609 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003610 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003611 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3612 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3613 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3614 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3615 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3616 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003617 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003618 used instead.
3619
3620 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3621 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3622 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3623 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3624
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003625 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3626 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3627 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3628
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003629 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003630
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003631 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003632 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3633 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003634
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003635 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3636 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3637 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003638
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003639 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003640 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003641 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3642 NTLM relies on.
3643
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003644 Examples :
3645 balance roundrobin
3646 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003647 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003648 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3649 balance hdr(host)
3650 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003651
3652 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3653 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3654
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003655 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003656 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3657 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3658 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003659 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003660
3661 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3662 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3663 defaults to 16 kB.
3664
3665 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3666 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3667
3668 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3669 Round Robin.
3670
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003671 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003672 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3673 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3674 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3675
3676 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3677
3678 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003679 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003680 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3681 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3682 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003683
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003684 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003685
3686
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003687bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3688bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003689 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3691 no | yes | yes | no
3692 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003693 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3694 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3695 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3696 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003697 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003698 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3699 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3700 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3701 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3702 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3703 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003704 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003705 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3706 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003707 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003708 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3709 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003710 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003711 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3712 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003713 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003714 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3715 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3716 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3717 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3718 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3719 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3720 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003721 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3722 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3723 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003724 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3725 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3726 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3727 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003728 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3729 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3730 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003731
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003732 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3733 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003734 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3735 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3736 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003737 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3738 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3739 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3740 the range.
3741
3742 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3743 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3744 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3745 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3746 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3747 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3748 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003749 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003750 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003751
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003752 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003753 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003754 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3755 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3756 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3757 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3758 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3759 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3760
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003761 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3762 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3763 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3764 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003765
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003766 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3767 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3768 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3769 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3770 in a frontend.
3771
3772 Example :
3773 listen http_proxy
3774 bind :80,:443
3775 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003776 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003777
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003778 listen http_https_proxy
3779 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003780 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003781
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003782 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3783 bind ipv6@:80
3784 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3785 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3786
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003787 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003788 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003789
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003790 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3791 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3792 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3793 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3794 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3795
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003796 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003797 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003798
3799
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003800bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003801 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3803 yes | yes | yes | yes
3804 Arguments :
3805 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3806 may be used to override a default value.
3807
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003808 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003809 option may be combined with other numbers.
3810
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003811 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003812 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3813 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3814 missing from all processes.
3815
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003816 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003817 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003818 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3819 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3820 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3821 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3822 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003823 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003824
3825 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3826 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3827 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3828 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3829 and 'even' instances.
3830
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003831 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3832 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3833 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3834 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003835
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003836 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3837 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3838
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003839 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3840 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3841 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3842
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003843 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3844 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3845
3846 Example :
3847 listen app_ip1
3848 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003849 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003850
3851 listen app_ip2
3852 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003853 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003854
3855 listen management
3856 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003857 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003858
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003859 listen management
3860 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3861 bind-process 1-4
3862
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003863 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003864
3865
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003866capture cookie <name> len <length>
3867 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3869 no | yes | yes | no
3870 Arguments :
3871 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3872 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3873 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3874 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003875 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003876
3877 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3878 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3879 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3880 right if it exceeds <length>.
3881
3882 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3883 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3884 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3885 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3886
3887 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3888 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3889 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3890
3891 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3892 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3893 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003894 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3895 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3896 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003897
3898 Example:
3899 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3900
3901 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003902 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003903
3904
3905capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003906 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3908 no | yes | yes | no
3909 Arguments :
3910 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003911 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003912 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3913 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3914 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3915
3916 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3917 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3918 it exceeds <length>.
3919
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003920 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003921 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3922 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003923 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3924 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3925 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3926 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003927 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003928 environments to find where the request came from.
3929
3930 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3931 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3932 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3933 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003934
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003935 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3936 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3937 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3938 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3939 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003940
3941 Example:
3942 capture request header Host len 15
3943 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003944 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003945
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003946 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003947 about logging.
3948
3949
3950capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003951 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3953 no | yes | yes | no
3954 Arguments :
3955 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003956 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003957 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3958 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3959 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3960
3961 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3962 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3963 it exceeds <length>.
3964
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003965 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003966 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3967 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3968 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003969 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3970 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3971 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3972 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003973
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003974 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3975 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3976 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3977 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3978 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003979
3980 Example:
3981 capture response header Content-length len 9
3982 capture response header Location len 15
3983
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003984 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003985 about logging.
3986
3987
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003988clitcpka-cnt <count>
3989 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
3990 the connection on the client side.
3991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3992 yes | yes | yes | no
3993 Arguments :
3994 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
3995
3996 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
3997 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003998 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3999 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004000
4001 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4002
4003
4004clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4005 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4006 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4007 client side.
4008 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4009 yes | yes | yes | no
4010 Arguments :
4011 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4012 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4013 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4014 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4015
4016 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4017 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004018 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4019 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004020
4021 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4022
4023
4024clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4025 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4027 yes | yes | yes | no
4028 Arguments :
4029 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4030 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4031 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4032 document.
4033
4034 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4035 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004036 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4037 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004038
4039 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4040
4041
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004042compression algo <algorithm> ...
4043compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004044compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004045 Enable HTTP compression.
4046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4047 yes | yes | yes | yes
4048 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004049 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4050 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
4051 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
4052
4053 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004054 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4055 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4056 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004057
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004058 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004059 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004060
4061 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4062 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4063 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4064 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4065 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004066 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004067
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004068 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4069 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4070 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4071 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4072 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4073 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4074 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004075 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004076
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004077 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004078 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004079 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
4080 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
4081 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
4082 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
4083 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004084
4085 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4086 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4087 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4088 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
4089 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004090 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4091 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4092 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4093 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4094 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004095 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4096 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004097
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004098 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004099 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4100 "Accept-Encoding" header
4101 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004102 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004103 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4104 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4105 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4106 "multipart"
4107 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4108 header
4109 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4110 and later
4111 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4112 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004113 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004114
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004115 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004116
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004117 Examples :
4118 compression algo gzip
4119 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004120
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004121
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004122cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004123 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4124 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004125 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004126 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4128 yes | no | yes | yes
4129 Arguments :
4130 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4131 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4132 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4133 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4134 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4135 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004136 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004137 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4138 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4139
4140 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
4141 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
4142 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4143 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4144 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4145 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004146 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4147 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004148 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004149 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4150 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004151
4152 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004153 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004154
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004155 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004156 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004157 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004158 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004159 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4160 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4161 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4162 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4163 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4164 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4165 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004166
4167 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4168 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4169 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4170 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4171 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4172 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4173 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4174 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4175 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004176 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004177 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4178 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4179 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004180
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004181 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4182 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4183 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004184 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4185 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4186 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4187 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004188 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4189 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4190 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004191
4192 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4193 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4194 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4195 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4196 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4197 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4198 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4199 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4200 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4201
4202 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4203 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4204 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4205 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4206 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4207 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4208 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4209 persistence cookie in the cache.
4210 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4211
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004212 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4213 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
4214 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
4215 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4216 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004217 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004218 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4219 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4220 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4221 they logout.
4222
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004223 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
4224 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4225 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4226 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4227
4228 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
4229 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4230 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4231 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4232 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4233 this attribute.
4234
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004235 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004236 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004237 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4238 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4239 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4240 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4241 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4242 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004243
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004244 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4245 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4246 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4247 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4248 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4249 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4250 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4251 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004252 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004253 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4254 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4255 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4256 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4257 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4258 the site.
4259
4260 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4261 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4262 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4263 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4264 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4265 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4266 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4267 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4268 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4269 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4270 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4271 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4272 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004273 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004274 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4275 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4276
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004277 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4278 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4279 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4280 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4281 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4282 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4283
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004284 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4285 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4286 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4287 repeated.
4288
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004289 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4290 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4291 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4292 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004293
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004294 Examples :
4295 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4296 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4297 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004298 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004299
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004300 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004301
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004302
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004303declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4304 Declares a capture slot.
4305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4306 no | yes | yes | no
4307 Arguments:
4308 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4309
4310 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4311 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4312 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4313 for use in the response.
4314
4315 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004316 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004317 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4318
4319
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004320default-server [param*]
4321 Change default options for a server in a backend
4322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4323 yes | no | yes | yes
4324 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004325 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4326 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4327 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4328 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004329
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004330 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004331 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4332
4333 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004334
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004335
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004336default_backend <backend>
4337 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4339 yes | yes | yes | no
4340 Arguments :
4341 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4342
4343 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4344 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4345 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4346 will catch all undetermined requests.
4347
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004348 Example :
4349
4350 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4351 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4352 default_backend dynamic
4353
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004354 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004355
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004356
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004357description <string>
4358 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4360 no | yes | yes | yes
4361 Arguments : string
4362
4363 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4364 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4365 it describes.
4366 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4367
4368
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004369disabled
4370 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4372 yes | yes | yes | yes
4373 Arguments : none
4374
4375 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4376 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4377 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4378 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4379 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4380 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4381 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4382
4383 See also : "enabled"
4384
4385
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004386dispatch <address>:<port>
4387 Set a default server address
4388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4389 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004390 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004391
4392 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4393 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4394 during start-up.
4395
4396 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4397 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4398 possible with normal servers.
4399
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004400 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004401 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4402 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4403 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4404 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4405
4406 See also : "server"
4407
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004408
4409dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4410 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4412 yes | no | yes | yes
4413 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4414
4415 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004416 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004417 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4418 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004419 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004420 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004421
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004422enabled
4423 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4425 yes | yes | yes | yes
4426 Arguments : none
4427
4428 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4429 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4430
4431 See also : "disabled"
4432
4433
4434errorfile <code> <file>
4435 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4437 yes | yes | yes | yes
4438 Arguments :
4439 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004440 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004441 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004442
4443 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004444 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004445 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004446 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4447 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004448
4449 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4450 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4451 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4452
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004453 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4454
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004455 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4456 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4457 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4458 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4459 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4460 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4461 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4462 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4463 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004464
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004465 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4466 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4467 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004468 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004469 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4470
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004471 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004472
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004473 Example :
4474 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004475 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004476 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4477 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4478
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004479
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004480errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4481 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4482 section.
4483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4484 yes | yes | yes | yes
4485 Arguments :
4486 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4487
4488 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004489 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004490 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004491
4492 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4493 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4494 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4495 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4496 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004497 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004498 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4499
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004500 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4501 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004502
4503 Example :
4504 errorfiles generic
4505 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4506
4507
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004508errorloc <code> <url>
4509errorloc302 <code> <url>
4510 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4512 yes | yes | yes | yes
4513 Arguments :
4514 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004515 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004516 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004517
4518 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4519 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4520 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4521 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004522 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004523
4524 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4525 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4526 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4527
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004528 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4529
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004530 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4531 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4532 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4533 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004534 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004535 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4536 request.
4537
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004538 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004539
4540
4541errorloc303 <code> <url>
4542 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4544 yes | yes | yes | yes
4545 Arguments :
4546 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004547 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004548 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004549
4550 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4551 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4552 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4553 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004554 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004555
4556 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4557 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4558 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4559
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004560 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4561
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004562 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4563 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4564 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4565 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004566 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004567
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004568 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004569
4570
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004571email-alert from <emailaddr>
4572 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004573 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004574 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4575 yes | yes | yes | yes
4576
4577 Arguments :
4578
4579 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4580
4581 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4582 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4583
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004584 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004585 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4586 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004587
4588
4589email-alert level <level>
4590 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4591 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4592 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4593 yes | yes | yes | yes
4594
4595 Arguments :
4596
4597 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4598 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4599 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4600
4601 By default level is alert
4602
4603 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4604 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4605 for the proxy.
4606
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004607 Alerts are sent when :
4608
4609 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4610 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4611 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4612 is notice or lower
4613 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4614 and a health check status update occurs
4615
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004616 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4617 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004618 section 3.6 about mailers.
4619
4620
4621email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4622 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4623 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4624 yes | yes | yes | yes
4625
4626 Arguments :
4627
4628 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4629
4630 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4631 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4632
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004633 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4634 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004635
4636
4637email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4638 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4639 mailers.
4640 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4641 yes | yes | yes | yes
4642
4643 Arguments :
4644
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004645 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004646
4647 By default the systems hostname is used.
4648
4649 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4650 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4651 for the proxy.
4652
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004653 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4654 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004655
4656
4657email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004658 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004659 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4660 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4661 yes | yes | yes | yes
4662
4663 Arguments :
4664
4665 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4666
4667 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4668 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4669
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004670 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004671 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4672
4673
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004674force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4675 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4676 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004677 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004678
4679 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4680 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4681 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4682 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4683 marked down for maintenance operations.
4684
4685 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4686 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4687 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4688 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4689 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4690 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4691 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4692 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4693 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4694
4695 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4696 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4697 is used.
4698
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004699 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004700 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004701
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004702
4703filter <name> [param*]
4704 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4706 no | yes | yes | yes
4707 Arguments :
4708 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4709 referenced in section 9.
4710
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004711 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004712 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004713 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4714 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004715
4716 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4717 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4718
4719 Example:
4720 listen
4721 bind *:80
4722
4723 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4724 filter compression
4725 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4726
4727 compression algo gzip
4728 compression offload
4729
4730 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4731
4732 See also : section 9.
4733
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004734
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004735fullconn <conns>
4736 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4738 yes | no | yes | yes
4739 Arguments :
4740 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4741 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4742
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004743 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004744 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004745 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004746 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4747 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4748 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4749 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4750 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004751 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004752
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004753 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4754 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004755 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4756 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4757 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004758
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004759 Example :
4760 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4761 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4762 # connections.
4763 backend dynamic
4764 fullconn 10000
4765 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4766 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4767
4768 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4769
4770
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02004771grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004772 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004774 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004775 Arguments :
4776 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4777 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4778 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4779
4780 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4781 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004782 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004783 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4784
4785 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4786 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4787 simplify it.
4788
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004789
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004790hash-balance-factor <factor>
4791 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4793 yes | no | no | yes
4794 Arguments :
4795 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4796 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004797 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004798
4799 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4800 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4801 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4802 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4803 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4804 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4805 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4806
4807 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4808 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4809 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4810 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4811 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4812
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004813 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4814 consistent hashing mechanism.
4815
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004816 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4817
4818
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004819hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004820 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4822 yes | no | yes | yes
4823 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004824 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4825 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004826
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004827 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4828 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4829 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4830 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4831 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4832 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4833 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4834 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4835 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4836 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004837
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004838 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4839 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4840 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4841 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4842 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4843 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4844 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4845 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4846 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4847 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4848 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4849 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4850 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004851 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4852 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004853
4854 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4855
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004856 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004857 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4858 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4859 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004860 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4861 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4862 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004863
4864 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4865 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004866 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4867 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4868 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4869 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4870
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004871 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4872 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4873 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4874 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4875 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4876 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4877 parameter.
4878
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004879 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4880 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4881 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4882 used on strings.
4883
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004884 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4885
4886 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4887 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4888 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4889 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4890 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4891 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4892 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4893 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4894 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4895 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4896 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4897 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004898
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004899 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4900 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4901 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004902
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004903 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004904
4905
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004906http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4907 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4908 ones).
4909
4910 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4911 no | yes | yes | yes
4912
4913 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4914 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4915 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4916 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4917 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4918 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4919
4920 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4921 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4922 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4923
4924 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4925 below.
4926
4927 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4928 instance.
4929
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01004930 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
4931 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
4932 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
4933
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004934 Example:
4935 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4936 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4937 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4938
4939http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4940
4941 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4942 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4943 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4944 example, or to pass some internal information.
4945 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4946 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4947 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4948
4949http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4950
4951 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4952 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4953
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00004954http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004955
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00004956 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
4957 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
4958 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
4959 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
4960 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004961
4962http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4963 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4964
4965 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4966
4967 Example:
4968 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4969
4970 # applied to:
4971 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4972
4973 # outputs:
4974 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4975
4976 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4977
4978http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4979 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4980
4981 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4982
4983 Example:
4984 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4985
4986 # applied to:
4987 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4988
4989 # outputs:
4990 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4991
4992http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4993
4994 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4995 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4996 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4997
4998http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4999 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5000
5001 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5002 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5003 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5004 fallback.
5005
5006 Example:
5007 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5008 http-response set-status 431
5009 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5010 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5011
5012http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5013
5014 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5015 inline.
5016
5017 Arguments:
5018 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5019 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5020 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5021 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5022 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5023 (request and response)
5024 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5025 processing
5026 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5027 processing
5028 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5029 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5030 and '_'.
5031
5032 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5033 followed by some converters.
5034
5035 Example:
5036 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5037
5038http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5039
5040 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5041 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5042 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5043 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5044 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005045 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005046 processing.
5047
5048 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5049 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005050 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005051 rules evaluation.
5052
5053http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5054
5055 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5056 details about <var-name>.
5057
5058 Example:
5059 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5060
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005061
5062http-check comment <string>
5063 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5064 it fails.
5065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5066 yes | no | yes | yes
5067
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005068 Arguments :
5069 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5070 rule fails.
5071
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005072 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5073 user-friendly error reporting.
5074
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005075 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005076 "http-check expect".
5077
5078
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005079http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5080 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005081 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005082 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5084 yes | no | yes | yes
5085
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005086 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005087 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5088
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005089 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005090 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005091
5092 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5093 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5094 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5095 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5096
5097 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5098
5099 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5100
5101 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5102
5103 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5104
5105 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5106
5107 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5108 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5109 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5110 is used.
5111
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005112 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5113 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5114 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5115 haproxy -vv.
5116
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005117 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5118
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005119 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5120 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5121 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5122 different ports or with different servers.
5123
5124 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5125 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5126 the port with a "http-check connect".
5127
5128 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5129 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5130 do.
5131
5132 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5133 unset-var or comment rules.
5134
5135 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005136 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5137 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5138 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5139 option httpchk
5140
5141 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005142 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005143 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005144 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005145 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005146 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005147
5148 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5149
5150 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005151
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005152
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005153http-check disable-on-404
5154 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005156 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005157 Arguments : none
5158
5159 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5160 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5161 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5162 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5163 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5164 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5165 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5166 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005167 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5168 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005169 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5170 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5171 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005172
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005173 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005174
5175
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005176http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005177 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5178 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5179 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005180 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005181 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005182 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005183
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005184 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005185 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5186
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005187 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5188 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5189 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5190 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5191 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5192 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5193 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5194 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5195 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5196 result is always conclusive.
5197
5198 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5199 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5200 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005201 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5202 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005203 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5204 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005205 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5206 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5207 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005208
5209 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5210 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005211 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5212 supported :
5213 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5214 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005215 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5216 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5217 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5218 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5219 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005220
5221 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5222 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005223 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5224 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5225 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5226 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005227 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5228
5229 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5230 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5231 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5232 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5233
5234 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5235 informational message reported in logs if an error
5236 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5237 log-format string.
5238
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005239 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005240 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5241 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005242 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5243 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5244 details on the supported keywords.
5245
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005246 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5247 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5248 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5249 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005250
5251 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5252 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5253 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5254 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5255 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5256
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005257 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5258 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5259 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5260 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5261 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5262 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5263 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005264
5265 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005266 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005267 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5268 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5269 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5270 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5271
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005272 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5273 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005274 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5275 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5276 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5277 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5278 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5279 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5280 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5281 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005282 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5283 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5284 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5285 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5286 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5287 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5288 insensitive on the header names.
5289
5290 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5291 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5292 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5293 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5294 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5295 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005296
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005297 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005298 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005299 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5300 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5301 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5302 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5303 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005304 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005305 trace).
5306
5307 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005308 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005309 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5310 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5311 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5312 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5313 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005314 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005315
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005316 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5317 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5318 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5319 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5320 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5321 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5322
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005323 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005324 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005325 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5326 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5327 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5328 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5329 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5330 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5331
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005332 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5333 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5334 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5335 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5336 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005337
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005338 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5339 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5340
5341 Examples :
5342 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005343 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005344
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005345 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5346 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5347
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005348 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005349 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005350
5351 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005352 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005353
5354 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005355 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005356
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005357 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005358 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005359
5360
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005361http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005362 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5363 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005364 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5365 health checks.
5366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5367 yes | no | yes | yes
5368 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005369 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5370
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005371 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5372 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5373 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5374 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5375 to invent non-standard ones.
5376
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005377 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5378 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5379 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5380 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5381
5382 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5383 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5384 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5385 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005386
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005387 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005388 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005389 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005390 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5391 to add it.
5392
5393 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5394 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5395 to the log-format rules.
5396
5397 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5398 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5399 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005400
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005401 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5402 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5403 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5404 request.
5405
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005406 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5407 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5408 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005409 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5410 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5411 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5412 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005413 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005414 "http-check expect" directive is defined independently of this directive, just
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005415 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
5416
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005417 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
5418 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005419 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send". If
5420 so, it will be ignored.
5421
5422 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5423 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5424 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5425 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5426 configured request authority.
5427
5428 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5429 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005430
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005431 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005432
5433
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005434http-check send-state
5435 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5437 yes | no | yes | yes
5438 Arguments : none
5439
5440 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5441 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5442 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5443 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5444 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5445
5446 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5447 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5448 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5449 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5450 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005451 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5452 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5453 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5454
5455 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5456 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5457 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5458
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005459 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5460 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5461 checked in multiple backends.
5462
5463 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5464 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5465
5466 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5467 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5468 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5469 one fails.
5470
5471 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5472 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5473 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5474
5475 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5476 server's queue.
5477
5478 Example of a header received by the application server :
5479 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5480 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5481
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005482 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5483 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005484
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005485
5486http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005487 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005488 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5489 yes | no | yes | yes
5490
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005491 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005492 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5493 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5494 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5495 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5496 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5497 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5498 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5499 and '-'.
5500
5501 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5502
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005503 Examples :
5504 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005505
5506
5507http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005508 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005509 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5510 yes | no | yes | yes
5511
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005512 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005513 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5514 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5515 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5516 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5517 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5518 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5519 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5520 and '-'.
5521
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005522 Examples :
5523 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005524
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005525
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005526http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5527 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5528 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5529 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5530 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5532 yes | yes | yes | yes
5533 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005534 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005535 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005536 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
5537 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005538
5539 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5540 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5541 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5542 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5543
5544 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5545 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5546 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5547 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5548
5549 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5550 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5551 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5552 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5553 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5554 chroot is performed.
5555
5556 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5557 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5558 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5559 considered.
5560
5561 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5562 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5563 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5564 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5565 considered as a raw string.
5566
5567 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5568 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5569 "content-type".
5570
5571 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5572 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5573 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5574 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5575 evaluated as a log-format string.
5576
5577 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5578 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5579 argument to "content-type".
5580
5581 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5582 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5583 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5584 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5585
5586 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5587 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5588 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5589 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5590 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5591 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5592 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5593 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5594
5595 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5596 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5597 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5598
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005599 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5600 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5601 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5602 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5603 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5604
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005605 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5606 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5607
5608
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005609http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005610 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5611
5612 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5613 no | yes | yes | yes
5614
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005615 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5616 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5617 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5618 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5619 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005620
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005621 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5622 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005623
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005624 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005625
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005626 Example:
5627 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5628 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5629 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005630
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005631 http-request allow if nagios
5632 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5633 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5634 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005635
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005636 Example:
5637 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5638 acl add path /addacl
5639 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005640
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005641 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005642
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005643 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5644 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005645
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005646 Example:
5647 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5648 acl setmap path /setmap
5649 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005650
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005651 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005652
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005653 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5654 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005655
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005656 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5657 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005658
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005659http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005660
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005661 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5662 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5663 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5664 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5665 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5666 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5667 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5668 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005669
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005670http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005671
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005672 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5673 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5674 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5675 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5676 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5677 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5678 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5679 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005680
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005681http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005682
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005683 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5684 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005685
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005686
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005687http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005688
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005689 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5690 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5691 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5692 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5693 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005694
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005695 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5696 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5697 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5698 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5699 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5700 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5701 instead.
5702
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005703 Example:
5704 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5705 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005706
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005707http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005708
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005709 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005710
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005711http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5712 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005713
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005714 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5715 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5716 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5717 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5718 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5719 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5720 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5721 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5722 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005723
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005724 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5725 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5726 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005727 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5728
5729 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5730 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5731 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5732 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005733
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005734http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005735
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005736 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5737 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5738 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5739 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5740 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5741 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005742
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005743http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005744
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005745 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5746 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5747 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5748 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5749 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005750
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005751http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005752
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005753 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5754 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5755 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5756 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5757 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5758 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005759
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005760http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5761http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5762 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5763 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5764 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5765 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005766
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005767 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5768 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5769 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005770 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005771 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5772 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5773 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005774 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005775 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005776
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005777http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5778 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5779 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5780 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5781
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005782http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5783
5784 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5785 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5786 pointed by <resolvers>.
5787 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5788 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5789 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5790 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5791 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5792 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5793 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5794 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5795 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5796 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5797 to 0.0.0.0.
5798
5799 Example:
5800 resolvers mydns
5801 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5802 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5803 timeout retry 1s
5804 hold valid 10s
5805 hold nx 3s
5806 hold other 3s
5807 hold obsolete 0s
5808 accepted_payload_size 8192
5809
5810 frontend fe
5811 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5812 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5813 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5814
5815 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5816 # which mean DNS resolution error
5817 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5818
5819 default_backend be
5820
5821 backend b_503
5822 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5823 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5824 # 503 error page to end users
5825
5826 backend be
5827 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5828 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5829 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5830 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5831 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5832
5833 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5834 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5835
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005836http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5837
5838 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5839 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5840 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5841 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005842 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5843 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005844
5845 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5846
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005847http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005848
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005849 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5850 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5851 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5852 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5853 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005854
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005855http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005856
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005857 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5858 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5859 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5860 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005861
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005862http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5863 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005864
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005865 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005866 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5867 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5868 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5869 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5870 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005871
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005872 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5873 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5874 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5875 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5876 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005877
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005878 Example:
5879 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5880
5881 # applied to:
5882 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5883
5884 # outputs:
5885 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5886
5887 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005888
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005889 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5890
5891 # applied to:
5892 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005893
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005894 # outputs:
5895 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005896
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005897http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5898 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5899
5900 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5901 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02005902 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
5903 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
5904 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005905
5906 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5907 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5908 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5909
5910 Example:
5911 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5912 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5913
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005914 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5915 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5916 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5917 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5918
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02005919http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5920 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5921
5922 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
5923 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
5924 query-string are replaced.
5925
5926 Example:
5927 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5928 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5929
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005930http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5931 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5932
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005933 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5934 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5935 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5936 against.
5937
5938 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5939 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5940 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005941
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005942 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5943 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5944 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5945 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5946 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5947 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5948 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5949 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5950 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005951 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5952 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005953
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005954 Example:
5955 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5956 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005957
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005958 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5959 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005960
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005961http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5962 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005963
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005964 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5965 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5966 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5967 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005968
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005969 Example:
5970 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005971
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005972 # applied to:
5973 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005974
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005975 # outputs:
5976 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005977
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005978http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5979 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5980 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005981 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005982 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5983
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005984 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005985 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5986 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005987 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005988 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005989 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005990 are followed to create the response :
5991
5992 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5993 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5994 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5995 ignored.
5996
5997 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5998 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005999 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006000 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
6001 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006002
6003 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6004 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6005 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006006 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006007 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006008
6009 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6010 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6011 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006012 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006013 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
6014 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006015
6016 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6017 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6018 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6019 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6020 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6021 as a raw content.
6022
6023 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6024 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6025 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6026 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6027 considered as a raw string.
6028
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006029 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006030 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6031 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6032 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6033
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006034 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6035 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006036 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006037
6038 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6039
6040 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006041 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006042 if { path /ping }
6043
6044 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6045 if { path /favicon.ico }
6046
6047 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6048 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6049 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6050
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006051http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6052http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006053
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006054 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6055 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6056 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006057
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006058http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6059 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006060
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006061 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6062 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6063 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6064 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006065
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006066http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006067
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006068 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6069 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6070 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6071 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6072 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006073
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006074 Arguments:
6075 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6076 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006077
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006078 Example:
6079 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6080 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006081
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006082 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6083 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006084
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006085http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006086
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006087 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6088 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6089 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006090
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006091 Arguments:
6092 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6093 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006094
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006095 Example:
6096 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6097 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006098
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006099 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6100 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6101 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006102
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006103http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006104
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006105 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6106 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6107 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6108 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6109 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006110
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006111 Example:
6112 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6113 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6114 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6115 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6116 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6117 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6118 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6119 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6120 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006121
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006122http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006123
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006124 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6125 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6126 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6127 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6128 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006129
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006130http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6131 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006132
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006133 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6134 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6135 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6136 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6137 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6138 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6139 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6140 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6141 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006142
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006143http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006144
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006145 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6146 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6147 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6148 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6149 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6150 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6151 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006152
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006153http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006154
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006155 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6156 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6157 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006158
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006159http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006160
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006161 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6162 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6163 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6164 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6165 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6166 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6167 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6168 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006169
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006170http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006171
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006172 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6173 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6174 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6175 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6176 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6177 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006178
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006179 Example :
6180 # prepend the host name before the path
6181 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006182
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006183http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6184
6185 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6186 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6187 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6188
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006189http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006190
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006191 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6192 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6193 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6194 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6195 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006196
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006197http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006198
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006199 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6200 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6201 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6202 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6203 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6204 values have higher priority.
6205 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6206 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6207 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6208 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6209 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006210
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006211http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006212
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006213 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6214 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6215 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6216 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6217 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6218 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6219 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006220
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006221 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006222
6223 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006224 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6225 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006226
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006227http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6228 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6229 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6230 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006231 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6232 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006233
6234 Arguments :
6235 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6236 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006237
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006238 See also "option forwardfor".
6239
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006240 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006241 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6242 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6243
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006244 # After the masking this will track connections
6245 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6246 http-request track-sc0 src
6247
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006248 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6249 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6250
6251http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6252
6253 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6254 expression.
6255
6256 Arguments:
6257 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6258 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006259
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006260 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006261 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6262 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6263
6264 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6265 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6266 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6267
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006268http-request set-timeout server|tunnel { <timeout> | <expr> }
6269 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6270
6271 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6272 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6273 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6274 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6275 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6276
6277 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6278 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6279 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6280 results.
6281
6282 Example:
6283 http-request set-timeout server 5s
6284 http-request set-timeout hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
6285
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006286http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6287
6288 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6289 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6290 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6291 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6292 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6293 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6294 information from the request.
6295
6296 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6297
6298http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6299
6300 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6301 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6302 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6303 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6304 path and the query string.
6305 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6306
6307http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6308
6309 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6310 inline.
6311
6312 Arguments:
6313 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6314 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6315 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6316 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6317 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6318 (request and response)
6319 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6320 processing
6321 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6322 processing
6323 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6324 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6325 and '_'.
6326
6327 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6328 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006329
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006330 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006331 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006332
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006333http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6334 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006335
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006336 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6337 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6338 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6339 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6340 agent name must be used.
6341
6342 Arguments:
6343 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6344
6345 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6346 configuration.
6347
6348http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6349
6350 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6351 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6352 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6353 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6354 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6355 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6356 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6357 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6358 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6359 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6360 action.
6361 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6362 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6363 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6364 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6365 you fully understand how it works.
6366
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006367http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6368
6369 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6370 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6371 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6372 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6373 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006374 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006375 processing.
6376
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006377 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006378 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6379 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6380 rules evaluation.
6381
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006382http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6383http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6384 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6385 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6386 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6387 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006388
6389 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6390 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6391 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006392 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6393 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6394 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6395 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6396 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6397 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6398 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6399 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6400 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6401 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006402 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006403 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6404 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6405 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6406 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6407 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006408
6409http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6410http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6411http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6412
6413 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6414 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6415 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6416 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006417 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006418 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6419 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6420 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6421 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6422 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6423 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6424 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6425
6426 Arguments :
6427 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6428 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6429 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6430 select which table entry to update the counters.
6431
6432 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6433 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6434 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6435 that table until the session ends.
6436
6437 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6438 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6439 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6440 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6441 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6442 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6443 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6444 useful information.
6445
6446 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6447 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6448 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6449 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6450 checks that make use of it.
6451
6452http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6453
6454 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006455
6456 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006457 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006458
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006459http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6460
6461 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6462 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6463 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6464 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6465 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6466 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6467
6468 Arguments :
6469 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6470
6471 Example:
6472 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6473
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006474http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006475
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006476 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6477 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6478 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006479
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006480
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006481http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006482 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6483
6484 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6485 no | yes | yes | yes
6486
6487 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6488 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6489 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6490 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6491 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6492 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6493
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006494 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6495 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006496
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006497 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006498
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006499 Example:
6500 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006501
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006502 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006503
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006504 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6505 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006506
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006507 Example:
6508 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006509
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006510 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006511
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006512 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6513 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006514
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006515 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6516 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006517
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006518http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006519
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006520 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6521 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6522 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6523 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6524 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6525 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6526 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6527 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006528
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006529http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006530
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006531 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6532 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6533 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6534 example, or to pass some internal information.
6535 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6536 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6537 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006538
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006539http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006540
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006541 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6542 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006543
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006544http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006545
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006546 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006547
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006548http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006549
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006550 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6551 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6552 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6553 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6554 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6555 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6556 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006557
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006558 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6559 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6560 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6561 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6562 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006563
6564 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6565 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6566 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6567 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006568
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006569http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006570
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006571 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6572 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6573 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6574 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6575 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6576 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006577
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006578http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006579
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006580 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6581 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6582 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6583 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6584 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006585
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006586http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006587
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006588 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6589 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6590 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6591 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6592 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6593 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006594
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006595http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6596http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6597 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6598 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6599 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6600 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006601
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006602 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6603 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6604 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006605 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006606 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6607 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6608 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006609 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006610 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006611
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006612http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006613
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006614 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6615 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6616 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6617 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6618 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6619 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006620
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006621http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6622 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006623
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006624 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6625 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006626
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006627 Example:
6628 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006629
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006630 # applied to:
6631 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006632
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006633 # outputs:
6634 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006635
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006636 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006637
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006638http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6639 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006640
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006641 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006642 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006643
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006644 Example:
6645 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006646
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006647 # applied to:
6648 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006649
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006650 # outputs:
6651 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006652
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006653http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6654 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6655 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006656 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006657 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6658
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006659 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006660 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6661 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006662 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006663 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006664 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006665 are followed to create the response :
6666
6667 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6668 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6669 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6670 ignored.
6671
6672 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6673 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006674 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006675 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
6676 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006677
6678 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6679 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6680 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006681 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006682 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006683
6684 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6685 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6686 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006687 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006688 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
6689 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006690
6691 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6692 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6693 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6694 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6695 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6696 as a raw content.
6697
6698 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6699 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6700 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6701 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6702 considered as a raw string.
6703
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006704 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6705 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6706 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6707 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6708
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006709 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6710 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006711 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006712
6713 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6714
6715 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006716 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006717 if { status eq 404 }
6718
6719 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6720 string "This is the end !" \
6721 if { status eq 500 }
6722
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006723http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6724http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006725
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006726 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6727 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6728 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006729
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006730http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6731 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006732
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006733 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6734 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6735 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6736 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006737
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006738http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006739
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006740 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6741 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6742 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6743 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6744 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006745
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006746 Arguments:
6747 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006748
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006749 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6750 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006751
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006752http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006753
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006754 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6755 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6756 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006757
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006758http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6759
6760 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6761 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6762 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6763 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6764 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6765
6766http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6767
6768 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6769 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6770 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6771 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6772 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6773 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6774 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6775 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6776 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6777
6778http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6779
6780 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6781 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6782 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6783 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6784 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6785 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6786 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6787
6788http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6789
6790 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6791 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6792 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6793 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6794 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6795 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6796 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6797 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6798
6799http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6800 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6801
6802 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6803 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6804 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6805 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006806
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006807 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006808 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6809 http-response set-status 431
6810 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6811 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006812
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006813http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006814
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006815 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6816 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6817 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6818 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6819 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6820 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6821 based on some information from the request.
6822
6823 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6824
6825http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6826
6827 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6828 inline.
6829
6830 Arguments:
6831 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6832 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6833 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6834 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6835 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6836 (request and response)
6837 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6838 processing
6839 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6840 processing
6841 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6842 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6843 and '_'.
6844
6845 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6846 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006847
6848 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006849 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006850
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006851http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006852
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006853 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6854 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6855 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6856 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6857 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6858 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6859 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6860 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6861 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6862 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6863 action.
6864 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6865 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6866 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6867 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6868 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006869
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006870http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6871
6872 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6873 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6874 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6875 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6876 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006877 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006878 processing.
6879
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006880 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006881 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006882 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006883 rules evaluation.
6884
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006885http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6886http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6887http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006888
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006889 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6890 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6891 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6892 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6893 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6894 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6895
6896http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6897
6898 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6899 about <var-name>.
6900
6901 Example:
6902 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6903
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006904
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006905http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6906 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6907
6908 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6909 yes | no | yes | yes
6910
6911 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006912 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6913 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6914 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006915
6916 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6917
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006918 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6919 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6920 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6921 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6922 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6923 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6924 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6925 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6926 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6927 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006928
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006929 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6930 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6931 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6932 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6933 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6934 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6935 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02006936 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
6937 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
6938 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
6939 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
6940 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
6941 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006942
6943 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6944 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6945 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6946 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6947 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6948 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6949 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6950 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006951 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006952 downsides of rare connection failures.
6953
6954 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6955 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6956 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6957 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6958 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6959 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006960 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006961 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6962 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6963 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6964 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6965 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6966
6967 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006968 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6969 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6970 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006971
Amaury Denoyelle7239c242020-10-15 16:41:09 +02006972 - connections sent to a server with a variable value as TLS SNI extension
6973 are marked private and are never shared. This is not the case if the SNI
6974 is guaranteed to be a constant, as for example using a literal string;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006975
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006976 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6977 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006978
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006979 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006980
6981 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6982 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6983 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6984
6985 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6986
6987
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006988http-send-name-header [<header>]
6989 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006990 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6991 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006992 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006993 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6994
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006995 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6996 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6997 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6998 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6999 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7000 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7001 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7002 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7003 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7004 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7005 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7006 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7007 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7008 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7009 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7010 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007011
7012 See also : "server"
7013
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007014id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007015 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7017 no | yes | yes | yes
7018 Arguments : none
7019
7020 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7021 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7022 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007023
7024
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007025ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7026 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7027 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007028 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007029
7030 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7031 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7032 and running).
7033
7034 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7035 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7036 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007037 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007038 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7039
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007040 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7041 "unless" condition is met.
7042
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007043 Example:
7044 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7045 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7046 ignore-persist if url_static
7047
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007048 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7049
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007050load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7051 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7052 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7053 yes | no | yes | yes
7054
7055 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7056 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7057 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007058 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007059 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
7060 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7061 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7062 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7063
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007064 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007065 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007066 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007067
7068 Arguments:
7069 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7070 named "server-state-file".
7071
7072 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7073 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7074 name is used as a file name.
7075
7076 none don't load any stat for this backend
7077
7078 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007079 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7080 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7081 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007082 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007083 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007084
7085 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7086 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7087
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007088 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007089
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007090 global
7091 stats socket /tmp/socket
7092 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007093
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007094 defaults
7095 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007096
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007097 backend bk
7098 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7099 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007100
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007101
7102 Then one can run :
7103
7104 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7105
7106 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7107
7108 1
7109 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7110 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7111 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7112
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007113 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007114
7115 global
7116 stats socket /tmp/socket
7117 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7118
7119 defaults
7120 load-server-state-from-file local
7121
7122 backend bk
7123 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7124 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7125
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007126
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007127 Then one can run :
7128
7129 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7130
7131 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7132
7133 1
7134 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7135 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7136 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7137
7138 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7139 "show servers state"
7140
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007141
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007142log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007143log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
7144 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007145no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007146 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7148 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007149
7150 Prefix :
7151 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7152 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7153 prefix does not allow arguments.
7154
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007155 Arguments :
7156 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7157 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7158 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7159 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7160 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7161 parameter.
7162
7163 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7164 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7165
7166 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7167 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7168 standard syslog port).
7169
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007170 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7171 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7172 standard syslog port).
7173
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007174 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7175 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7176 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007177 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007178
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007179 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7180 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7181 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7182 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7183 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7184 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7185 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7186 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7187 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7188 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7189 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7190 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
7191 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
7192 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7193 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7194 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007195 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7196 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007197
7198 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7199 and "fd@2", see above.
7200
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007201 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7202 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7203 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7204 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7205 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7206 having the logs instantly available.
7207
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007208 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7209 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007210
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007211 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7212 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7213 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7214 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7215 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7216 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7217 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7218 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7219 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7220 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007221 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007222
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007223 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7224 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7225 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7226 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7227 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7228
7229 <sample_size>
7230 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7231 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7232 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7233 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7234 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7235
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007236 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7237 one of the following :
7238
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007239 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7240 field is stripped. This is the default.
7241 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7242 rfc3164.
7243
7244 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007245 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7246
7247 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7248 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7249
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007250 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7251 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7252 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7253 designed to be used with a local log server.
7254
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007255 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7256 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7257 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7258 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7259 systemd logger consumes.
7260
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007261 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7262 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7263 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7264 used with a local log server.
7265
7266 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7267 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7268 designed to be used with a local log server.
7269
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007270 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7271 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7272 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7273 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7274
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007275 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7276
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007277 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7278 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7279 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7280
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007281 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7282 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7283 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7284 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007285
7286 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7287 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7288 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007289 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7290 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7291 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7292 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7293 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007294
7295 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7296
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007297 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7298 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7299 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007300
7301 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7302 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7303 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7304 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7305
7306 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7307 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007308
7309 Example :
7310 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007311 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7312 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7313 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007314 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
7315 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007316 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007317
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007318
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007319log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007320 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7321 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7322 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007323
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007324 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7325 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7326 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7327 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7328 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007329
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007330 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7331 "option httplog" directives.
7332
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007333log-format-sd <string>
7334 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7335 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7336 yes | yes | yes | no
7337
7338 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7339 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7340 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7341 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7342 which covers the log format string in depth.
7343
7344 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7345 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7346
7347 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7348 log format to "rfc5424".
7349
7350 Example :
7351 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7352
7353
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007354log-tag <string>
7355 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7356 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7357 yes | yes | yes | yes
7358
7359 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7360 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7361 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7362 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7363 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7364 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7365 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7366 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7367 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007368
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007369max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7370 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7371 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7372 yes | no | yes | yes
7373
7374 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7375 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7376 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7377 servers.
7378
7379 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7380 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7381 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7382 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7383 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007384 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007385 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7386 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7387 picking a different server.
7388
7389 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7390 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7391 even if they have to be queued.
7392
7393 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7394 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7395
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007396max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7397 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7398 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7399 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007400
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007401maxconn <conns>
7402 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7404 yes | yes | yes | no
7405 Arguments :
7406 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7407 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7408 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7409 closes.
7410
7411 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7412 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7413 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7414 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007415 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7416 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7417 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7418 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007419
7420 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7421 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7422 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7423
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007424 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7425 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007426
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007427 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7428
7429
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007430mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007431 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7433 yes | yes | yes | yes
7434 Arguments :
7435 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7436 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7437 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7438 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7439
7440 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7441 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7442 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7443 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7444 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7445
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007446 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7447 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7448 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007449
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007450 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007451 defaults http_instances
7452 mode http
7453
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007454
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007455monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007456 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7458 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007459 Arguments :
7460 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7461 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007462 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007463 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7464 backend and its backup.
7465
7466 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7467 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7468 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7469 servers in a list of backends.
7470
7471 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7472 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7473 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7474 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7475 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7476 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7477 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007478 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7479 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007480
7481 Example:
7482 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007483 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007484 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7485 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7486 monitor-uri /site_alive
7487 monitor fail if site_dead
7488
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007489 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007490
7491
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007492monitor-uri <uri>
7493 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7495 yes | yes | yes | no
7496 Arguments :
7497 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7498 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7499
7500 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7501 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7502 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7503 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7504 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7505 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7506 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7507 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7508
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007509 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007510 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7511 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7512 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7513 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7514 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7515 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007516
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007517 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7518 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7519 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7520 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7521
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007522 Example :
7523 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7524 frontend www
7525 mode http
7526 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7527
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007528 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007529
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007530
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007531option abortonclose
7532no option abortonclose
7533 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7535 yes | no | yes | yes
7536 Arguments : none
7537
7538 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7539 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7540 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7541 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007542 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007543 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7544 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7545 encountered while delivering the response.
7546
7547 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7548 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7549 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7550 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7551 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7552 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007553 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007554 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007555 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007556 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7557 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7558 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7559
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007560 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7561 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007562 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7563 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7564 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7565 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7566 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7567 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007568 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007569
7570 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7571 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7572
7573 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7574
7575
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007576option accept-invalid-http-request
7577no option accept-invalid-http-request
7578 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7580 yes | yes | yes | no
7581 Arguments : none
7582
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007583 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007584 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007585 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007586 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7587 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7588 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7589 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7590 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007591 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7592 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7593 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7594 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007595 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007596 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007597 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7598 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7599 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007600
7601 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7602 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7603 been confirmed.
7604
7605 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7606 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007607 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7608 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007609 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7610
7611 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7612 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7613
7614 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7615 stats socket.
7616
7617
7618option accept-invalid-http-response
7619no option accept-invalid-http-response
7620 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7622 yes | no | yes | yes
7623 Arguments : none
7624
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007625 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007626 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007627 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007628 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7629 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7630 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7631 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7632 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007633 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7634 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7635 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007636
7637 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7638 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7639 been confirmed.
7640
7641 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7642 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7643 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7644 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7645
7646 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7647 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7648
7649 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7650 stats socket.
7651
7652
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007653option allbackups
7654no option allbackups
7655 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7657 yes | no | yes | yes
7658 Arguments : none
7659
7660 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7661 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7662 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7663 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7664 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7665 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7666 order between the backup servers anymore.
7667
7668 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7669 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7670
7671 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7672 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7673
7674
7675option checkcache
7676no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007677 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7679 yes | no | yes | yes
7680 Arguments : none
7681
7682 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7683 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007684 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007685 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7686 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007687 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007688
7689 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007690 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007691 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007692 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7693 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007694 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007695 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007696 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7697 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007698 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007699 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7700 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007701 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007702 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7703 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7704 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7705 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7706 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7707 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7708 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7709 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7710 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7711
7712 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007713 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7714 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7715 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7716 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007717
7718 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7719 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007720 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007721 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007722
7723 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7724 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7725
7726
7727option clitcpka
7728no option clitcpka
7729 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7731 yes | yes | yes | no
7732 Arguments : none
7733
7734 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7735 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007736 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007737 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7738
7739 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7740 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7741 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7742 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7743
7744 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7745 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7746 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7747 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7748 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7749
7750 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7751
7752 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7753 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7754 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7755
7756 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7757 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7758
7759 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7760
7761
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007762option contstats
7763 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7765 yes | yes | yes | no
7766 Arguments : none
7767
7768 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7769 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7770 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7771 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007772 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7773 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7774 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7775 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7776 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007777
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007778option disable-h2-upgrade
7779no option disable-h2-upgrade
7780 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7781 connection.
7782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7783 yes | yes | yes | no
7784 Arguments : none
7785
7786 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7787 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7788 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7789 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7790 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7791 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7792 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7793 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7794
7795 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7796 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007797
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007798option dontlog-normal
7799no option dontlog-normal
7800 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7802 yes | yes | yes | no
7803 Arguments : none
7804
7805 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7806 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7807 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7808 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7809 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7810 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7811 logged.
7812
7813 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7814 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7815 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7816
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007817 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007818 logging.
7819
7820
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007821option dontlognull
7822no option dontlognull
7823 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7825 yes | yes | yes | no
7826 Arguments : none
7827
7828 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7829 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7830 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7831 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7832 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7833 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007834 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7835 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7836 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007837
7838 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007839 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007840 would not be logged.
7841
7842 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7843 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7844
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007845 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007846 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007847
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007848
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007849option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007850 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7852 yes | yes | yes | yes
7853 Arguments :
7854 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7855 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007856 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007857 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007858
7859 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7860 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7861 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7862 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7863 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7864 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7865 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007866 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7867 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7868 possible that the client has already brought one.
7869
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007870 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007871 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007872 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007873 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007874 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007875 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007876
7877 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7878 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7879 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7880 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7881 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7882 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7883 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7884
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007885 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7886 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7887 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7888 are under the control of the end-user.
7889
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007890 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007891 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7892 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007893 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7894 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7895 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007896
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007897 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007898 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7899 frontend www
7900 mode http
7901 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7902
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007903 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7904 backend www
7905 mode http
7906 option forwardfor header X-Client
7907
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007908 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007909 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007910
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007911
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007912option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7913no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7914 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7916 yes | yes | yes | no
7917 Arguments : none
7918
7919 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7920 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7921 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7922 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7923 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7924 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7925 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7926
7927 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7928 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7929 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7930 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7931 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7932 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7933 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7934 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7935 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7936 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7937
7938 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7939
7940 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7941 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7942
7943 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7944 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7945
7946
7947option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7948no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7949 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7951 yes | no | yes | yes
7952 Arguments : none
7953
7954 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7955 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7956 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7957 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7958 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7959 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7960 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7961
7962 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7963 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7964 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7965 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7966 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7967 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7968 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7969 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7970 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7971 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7972
7973 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7974
7975 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7976 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7977
7978 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7979 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7980
7981
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007982option http-buffer-request
7983no option http-buffer-request
7984 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7986 yes | yes | yes | yes
7987 Arguments : none
7988
7989 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7990 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7991 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7992 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7993 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7994 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007995 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7996 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7997 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7998 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007999
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01008000 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008001
8002
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008003option http-ignore-probes
8004no option http-ignore-probes
8005 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8007 yes | yes | yes | no
8008 Arguments : none
8009
8010 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8011 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8012 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8013 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8014 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8015 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8016 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8017 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8018 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008019 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8020 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008021 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8022
8023 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8024 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8025 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8026 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8027 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8028 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8029 are often the only way to detect them.
8030
8031 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8032 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8033
8034 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8035
8036
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008037option http-keep-alive
8038no option http-keep-alive
8039 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8041 yes | yes | yes | yes
8042 Arguments : none
8043
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008044 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8045 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008046 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8047 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008048 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8049 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8050 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008051
8052 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8053 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008054 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8055 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8056 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8057 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8058 situations where this option may be useful :
8059
8060 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008061 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008062
8063 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8064 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8065
8066 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8067 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8068 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8069 request.
8070
8071 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8072 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008073 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8074 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8075 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008076
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008077 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8078 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8079 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8080 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8081 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8082 not set.
8083
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008084 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8085 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8086 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008087
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008088 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008089 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008090 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008091
8092
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008093option http-no-delay
8094no option http-no-delay
8095 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8097 yes | yes | yes | yes
8098 Arguments : none
8099
8100 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8101 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8102 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8103 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8104 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8105 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8106 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
8107 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
8108 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8109 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8110 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8111 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8112 affected.
8113
8114 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8115 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8116 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8117 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8118 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8119 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8120 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8121 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8122 latency environments.
8123
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008124 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8125
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008126
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008127option http-pretend-keepalive
8128no option http-pretend-keepalive
8129 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
8130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008131 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008132 Arguments : none
8133
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008134 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008135 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8136 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8137 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
8138 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
8139 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8140 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8141 consider the response complete.
8142
8143 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
8144 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
8145 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
8146 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008147 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008148 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8149
8150 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8151 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8152 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8153 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
8154 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
8155 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
8156 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8157
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008158 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8159 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8160 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8161 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8162 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8163 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008164
8165 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8166 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8167
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008168 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008169 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008170
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008171
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008172option http-server-close
8173no option http-server-close
8174 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8176 yes | yes | yes | yes
8177 Arguments : none
8178
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008179 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8180 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8181 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8182 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008183 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8184 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8185 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8186 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8187 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8188 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8189 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8190 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8191 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8192 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8193 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008194
8195 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8196 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8197 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8198 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008199 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8200 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008201
8202 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8203 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008204 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8205 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8206 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008207
8208 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8209 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8210
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008211 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8212 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008213
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008214option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008215no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008216 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8218 yes | yes | yes | no
8219 Arguments : none
8220
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008221 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008222 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8223 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8224 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8225 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8226 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
8227 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
8228
8229 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
8230 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008231 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8232 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8233 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008234
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008235 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8236 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8237 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8238 front of an existing proxy.
8239
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008240 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8241
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008242 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008243
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008244option httpchk
8245option httpchk <uri>
8246option httpchk <method> <uri>
8247option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008248 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8250 yes | no | yes | yes
8251 Arguments :
8252 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8253 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8254 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8255 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8256 ones.
8257
8258 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8259 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8260 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8261
8262 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8263 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8264 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008265 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008266
8267 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8268 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8269 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8270 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8271 the lack of any response.
8272
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008273 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8274 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8275 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8276 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8277
8278 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8279 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8280 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008281
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008282 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8283 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008284 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008285 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008286 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008287
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008288 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8289 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8290 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8291 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8292
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008293 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008294 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8295 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8296 backend https_relay
8297 mode tcp
8298 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8299 http-check send hdr Host www
8300 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008301
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008302 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8303 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8304 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008305
8306
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008307option httpclose
8308no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008309 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8311 yes | yes | yes | yes
8312 Arguments : none
8313
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008314 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8315 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8316 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8317 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008318 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008319
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008320 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8321 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008322 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008323 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8324 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008325
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008326 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8327 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8328 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008329
8330 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8331 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008332 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8333 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8334 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008335
8336 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8337 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8338
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008339 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008340
8341
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008342option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008343 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008345 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008346 Arguments :
8347 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8348 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8349 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008350 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008351 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008352
8353 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8354 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8355 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8356 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8357 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8358 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8359 ports.
8360
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008361 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8362 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008363
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008364 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8365
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008366 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008367
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008368
8369option http_proxy
8370no option http_proxy
8371 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8373 yes | yes | yes | yes
8374 Arguments : none
8375
8376 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8377 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8378 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8379 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8380 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8381
8382 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8383 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008384 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8385 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008386
8387 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8388 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8389
8390 Example :
8391 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8392 backend direct_forward
8393 option httpclose
8394 option http_proxy
8395
8396 See also : "option httpclose"
8397
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008398
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008399option independent-streams
8400no option independent-streams
8401 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8403 yes | yes | yes | yes
8404 Arguments : none
8405
8406 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8407 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8408 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8409 receive data or not.
8410
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008411 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008412 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8413 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8414 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8415 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8416 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8417 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8418 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8419 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8420 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8421 socket buffers.
8422
8423 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8424 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8425 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8426 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8427 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8428
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008429 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008430
8431
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008432option ldap-check
8433 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8435 yes | no | yes | yes
8436 Arguments : none
8437
8438 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8439 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8440 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8441 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8442
8443 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8444 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8445
8446 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8447 configure it.
8448
8449 Example :
8450 option ldap-check
8451
8452 See also : "option httpchk"
8453
8454
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008455option external-check
8456 Use external processes for server health checks
8457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8458 yes | no | yes | yes
8459
8460 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8461 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8462 command".
8463
8464 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8465
8466 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8467
8468
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008469option log-health-checks
8470no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008471 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8473 yes | no | yes | yes
8474 Arguments : none
8475
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008476 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8477 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8478 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008479
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008480 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8481 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8482 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8483 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8484 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8485
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008486 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008487 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008488
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008489 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8490 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8491 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008492
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008493
8494option log-separate-errors
8495no option log-separate-errors
8496 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8498 yes | yes | yes | no
8499 Arguments : none
8500
8501 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8502 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8503 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8504 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8505 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8506 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8507 provides very important information.
8508
8509 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8510 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8511 error logs.
8512
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008513 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008514 logging.
8515
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008516
8517option logasap
8518no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008519 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8521 yes | yes | yes | no
8522 Arguments : none
8523
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008524 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8525 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8526 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8527 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8528
8529 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8530 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8531 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8532 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8533 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008534 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008535 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8536 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8537 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8538 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008539 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008540
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008541 Examples :
8542 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8543 mode http
8544 option httplog
8545 option logasap
8546 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8547
8548 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8549 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8550 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8551 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8552
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008553 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008554 logging.
8555
8556
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008557option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008558 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8560 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008561 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008562 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8563 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008564 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8565 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008566
8567 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8568 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008569 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008570 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8571 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8572 in the MySQL table, like this :
8573
8574 USE mysql;
8575 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8576 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8577
8578 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008579 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008580 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8581 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8582 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8583 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8584 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8585 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8586 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8587
8588 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8589 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008590
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008591 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008592
8593 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8594 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8595 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8596 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008597 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8598 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008599
8600 See also: "option httpchk"
8601
8602
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008603option nolinger
8604no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008605 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008606 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8607 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008608 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008609
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008610 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008611 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8612 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8613 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8614 connections.
8615
8616 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8617 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008618 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
8619 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
8620 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
8621 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
8622 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
8623 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
8624 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
8625 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
8626 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
8627 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
8628 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
8629 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
8630 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008631
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008632 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
8633 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
8634 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
8635 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
8636 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008637
8638 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8639 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008640 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
8641 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidently
8642 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008643
8644 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8645 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8646
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008647 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
8648 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008649
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008650option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8651 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8653 yes | yes | yes | yes
8654 Arguments :
8655 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8656 matching <network>
8657 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8658 header name.
8659
8660 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8661 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8662 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8663 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8664 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8665 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8666 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8667 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8668 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8669 possible that the client has already brought one.
8670
8671 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8672 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8673 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8674 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8675 header and requires different one.
8676
8677 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8678 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8679 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8680 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8681 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8682 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8683 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8684
8685 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8686 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8687 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8688 both are defined.
8689
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008690 Examples :
8691 # Original Destination address
8692 frontend www
8693 mode http
8694 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8695
8696 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8697 backend www
8698 mode http
8699 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8700
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008701 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008702
8703
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008704option persist
8705no option persist
8706 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8707 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8708 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008709 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008710
8711 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8712 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8713 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8714 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8715 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8716 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8717 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8718 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8719 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8720 redirected to another valid server.
8721
8722 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8723 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8724
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008725 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008726
8727
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008728option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8729 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8731 yes | no | yes | yes
8732 Arguments :
8733 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8734 PostgreSQL server.
8735
8736 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8737 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8738 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8739 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8740
8741 See also: "option httpchk"
8742
8743
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008744option prefer-last-server
8745no option prefer-last-server
8746 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8747 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8748 yes | no | yes | yes
8749 Arguments : none
8750
8751 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8752 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8753 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8754 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8755 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8756 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8757 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8758 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8759 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008760 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8761 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008762 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8763 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8764 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008765 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8766 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8767 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008768
8769 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8770 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8771
8772 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8773
8774
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008775option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008776option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008777no option redispatch
8778 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8779 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8780 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008781 Arguments :
8782 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8783 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8784 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008785 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008786 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008787 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008788 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8789 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8790 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8791
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008792
8793 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8794 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8795 be able to access the service anymore.
8796
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008797 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8798 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008799
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008800 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8801 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8802 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8803 following order:
8804
8805 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8806
8807 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8808 list, or
8809
8810 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8811
8812 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8813 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8814
8815 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8816 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8817 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8818 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8819
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008820 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008821 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8822 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008823
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008824 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8825 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8826
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008827 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008828
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008829
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008830option redis-check
8831 Use redis health checks for server testing
8832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8833 yes | no | yes | yes
8834 Arguments : none
8835
8836 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8837 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8838 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8839 find the "+PONG" response message.
8840
8841 Example :
8842 option redis-check
8843
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008844 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008845
8846
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008847option smtpchk
8848option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8849 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8851 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008852 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008853 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008854 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008855 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8856
8857 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8858 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8859 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8860
8861 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8862 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8863 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8864 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8865 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8866 dead server.
8867
8868 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8869 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008870 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008871 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8872
8873 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8874 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8875 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8876 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008877 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008878
8879 Example :
8880 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8881
8882 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8883
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008884
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008885option socket-stats
8886no option socket-stats
8887
8888 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8890 yes | yes | yes | no
8891
8892 Arguments : none
8893
8894
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008895option splice-auto
8896no option splice-auto
8897 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8899 yes | yes | yes | yes
8900 Arguments : none
8901
8902 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8903 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008904 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008905 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008906 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008907 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8908 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8909 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8910 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8911
8912 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8913 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8914 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8915 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8916 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8917 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8918 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8919 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8920 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8921 keyword.
8922
8923 Example :
8924 option splice-auto
8925
8926 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8927 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8928
8929 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8930 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8931
8932
8933option splice-request
8934no option splice-request
8935 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8937 yes | yes | yes | yes
8938 Arguments : none
8939
8940 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008941 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008942 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8943 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8944 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8945 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8946
8947 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8948
8949 Example :
8950 option splice-request
8951
8952 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8953 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8954
8955 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8956 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8957
8958
8959option splice-response
8960no option splice-response
8961 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8963 yes | yes | yes | yes
8964 Arguments : none
8965
8966 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008967 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008968 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8969 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8970 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8971 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8972
8973 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8974
8975 Example :
8976 option splice-response
8977
8978 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8979 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8980
8981 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8982 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8983
8984
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008985option spop-check
8986 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8988 no | no | no | yes
8989 Arguments : none
8990
8991 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8992 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8993 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8994 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8995
8996 Example :
8997 option spop-check
8998
8999 See also : "option httpchk"
9000
9001
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009002option srvtcpka
9003no option srvtcpka
9004 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9006 yes | no | yes | yes
9007 Arguments : none
9008
9009 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9010 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009011 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009012 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9013
9014 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9015 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9016 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9017 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9018
9019 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9020 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9021 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9022 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9023 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9024
9025 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9026
9027 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9028 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9029 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9030
9031 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9032 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9033
9034 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9035
9036
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009037option ssl-hello-chk
9038 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9040 yes | no | yes | yes
9041 Arguments : none
9042
9043 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9044 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9045 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9046 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9047 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9048 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9049 hello message.
9050
9051 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9052 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9053 messages, which is appreciable.
9054
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009055 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
9056 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9057 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009058
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009059 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9060
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009061
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009062option tcp-check
9063 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9064 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9065 yes | no | yes | yes
9066
9067 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9068 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9069
9070 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9071 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9072 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9073
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009074 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009075 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9076 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9077 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9078 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9079 only.
9080
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009081 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009082 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
9083 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9084 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9085 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9086
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009087 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009088 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9089 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009090 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009091 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9092 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9093 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9094 the respective protocols.
9095 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009096 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009097
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009098 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009099
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009100 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9101 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9102 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9103 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009104
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009105 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9106 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9107 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009108
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009109
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009110 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009111 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009112 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009113 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009114
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009115 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009116 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009117 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009118
9119 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9120 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009121 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009122 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009123 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009124 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009125 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009126 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009127 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9128 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009129 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009130 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9131 tcp-check expect string +OK
9132
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009133 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009134 (send many headers before analyzing)
9135 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009136 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009137 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9138 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9139 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9140 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009141 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009142
9143
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009144 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009145
9146
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009147option tcp-smart-accept
9148no option tcp-smart-accept
9149 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9151 yes | yes | yes | no
9152 Arguments : none
9153
9154 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9155 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9156 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9157 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9158 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9159 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9160
9161 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9162 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9163 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9164 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9165
9166 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9167 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9168 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009169 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009170
9171 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9172 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9173 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9174
9175 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9176 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9177 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9178
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009179 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9180
9181
9182option tcp-smart-connect
9183no option tcp-smart-connect
9184 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9186 yes | no | yes | yes
9187 Arguments : none
9188
9189 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9190 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9191 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9192 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9193 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9194
9195 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9196 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9197 complex.
9198
9199 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9200 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9201 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9202
9203 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9204 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9205
9206 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9207
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009208
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009209option tcpka
9210 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9212 yes | yes | yes | yes
9213 Arguments : none
9214
9215 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9216 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009217 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009218 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9219
9220 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9221 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9222 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9223 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9224
9225 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9226 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9227 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9228 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9229 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9230
9231 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9232
9233 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9234 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9235 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9236 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9237 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9238 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9239 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9240 backends.
9241
9242 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9243
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009244
9245option tcplog
9246 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009248 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009249 Arguments : none
9250
9251 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9252 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9253 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9254 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9255 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9256 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9257 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9258 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9259
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009260 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9261
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009262 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009263
9264
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009265option transparent
9266no option transparent
9267 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009269 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009270 Arguments : none
9271
9272 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9273 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9274 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9275 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9276 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9277 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9278 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9279 appropriate server.
9280
9281 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9282 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9283
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009284 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009285 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009286
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009287
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009288external-check command <command>
9289 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9291 yes | no | yes | yes
9292
9293 Arguments :
9294 <command> is the external command to run
9295
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009296 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9297
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009298 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009299
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009300 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9301 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9302 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9303 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9304 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9305 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009306
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009307 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9308
9309 Environment variables :
9310 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9311 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9312
9313 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9314
9315 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9316
9317 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9318 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9319 for a UNIX socket).
9320
9321 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9322
9323 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9324
9325 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9326
9327 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9328
9329 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9330
9331 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9332 socket).
9333
9334 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9335 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9336
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009337 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9338
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009339 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9340 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9341 failed.
9342
9343 Example :
9344 external-check command /bin/true
9345
9346 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9347
9348
9349external-check path <path>
9350 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9352 yes | no | yes | yes
9353
9354 Arguments :
9355 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9356
9357 The default path is "".
9358
9359 Example :
9360 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9361
9362 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9363 "external-check command"
9364
9365
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009366persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009367persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009368 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9370 yes | no | yes | yes
9371 Arguments :
9372 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009373 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9374 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009375
9376 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9377 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009378 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009379 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9380 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9381 forwarded to this server.
9382
9383 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9384 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9385 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009386 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009387 a single "listen" section.
9388
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009389 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9390 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9391 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9392
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009393 Example :
9394 listen tse-farm
9395 bind :3389
9396 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9397 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9398 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9399 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9400 persist rdp-cookie
9401 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009402 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009403 balance rdp-cookie
9404 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9405 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9406
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009407 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9408 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009409
9410
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009411rate-limit sessions <rate>
9412 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9414 yes | yes | yes | no
9415 Arguments :
9416 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9417 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9418
9419 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9420 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9421 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9422 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9423 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9424 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9425
9426 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9427 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9428 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9429 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9430
9431 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9432 listen smtp
9433 mode tcp
9434 bind :25
9435 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009436 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009437
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009438 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9439 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9440 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009441
9442 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9443
9444
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009445redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9446redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9447redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009448 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9450 no | yes | yes | yes
9451
9452 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009453 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009454
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009455 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009456 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009457 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9458 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9459 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009460
9461 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9462 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9463 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9464 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9465 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009466 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9467 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9468 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9469 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009470
9471 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9472 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9473 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9474 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9475 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9476 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009477 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009478 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009479 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9480 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9481 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009482
9483 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009484 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9485 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9486 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009487 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009488 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9489 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9490 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9491 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009492
9493 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009494 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009495
9496 - "drop-query"
9497 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9498 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9499 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9500 with a location-type redirect.
9501
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009502 - "append-slash"
9503 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9504 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9505 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9506 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9507
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009508 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9509 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9510 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9511 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9512 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9513 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9514 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9515
9516 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9517 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9518 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9519 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9520 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9521 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9522 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009523
9524 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9525 acl clear dst_port 80
9526 acl secure dst_port 8080
9527 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009528 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009529 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009530 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9531
9532 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009533 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9534 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9535 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009536 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009537
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009538 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9539 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9540 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9541
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009542 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009543 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009544
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009545 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009546 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9547 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9548 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009549
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009550 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009551
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009552
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009553retries <value>
9554 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9555 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9556 yes | no | yes | yes
9557 Arguments :
9558 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9559 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9560 default value is 3.
9561
9562 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9563 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9564 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9565
9566 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009567 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9568 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009569
9570 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9571 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9572
9573 See also : "option redispatch"
9574
9575
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009576retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009577 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9578 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9579 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009580 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9581 yes | no | yes | yes
9582 Arguments :
9583 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9584 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9585 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9586 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9587
9588 none never retry
9589
9590 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9591 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9592
9593 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9594 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9595 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9596 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9597 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9598 processing the request.
9599
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009600 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9601 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9602 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9603 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9604 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9605 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9606 overflow attack for example).
9607
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009608 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9609 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9610 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9611 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9612 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9613 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9614 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9615 amplify denial of service attacks.
9616
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009617 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9618 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9619 considered to be safe to retry.
9620
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +01009621 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
9622 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
9623 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
9624 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
9625 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009626
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009627 all-retryable-errors
9628 retry request for any error that are considered
9629 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9630 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9631 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9632
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009633 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9634 not cumulative.
9635
9636 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9637 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9638 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9639 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9640
9641 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9642 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9643 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9644 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9645 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9646 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9647 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9648 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9649 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9650 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9651 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9652 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9653
9654 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9655 should not use this directive.
9656
9657 The default is "conn-failure".
9658
9659 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9660
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009661server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009662 Declare a server in a backend
9663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9664 no | no | yes | yes
9665 Arguments :
9666 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009667 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009668 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009669
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009670 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9671 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9672 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9673 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009674 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9675 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9676 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9677 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9678 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009679 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9680 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9681 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9682 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9683 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9684 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9685 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009686 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009687 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9688 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9689 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9690 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9691 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9692 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009693 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9694 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009695 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9696 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009697
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009698 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009699 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9700 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9701 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9702 adding this value to the client's port.
9703
9704 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9705 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009706 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009707
9708 Examples :
9709 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9710 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009711 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009712 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9713 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9714 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009715
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009716 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9717 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9718 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9719 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9720 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9721
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009722 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9723 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009724
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009725server-state-file-name [<file>]
9726 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
9727 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
9728 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
9729 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
9730 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
9731 global directive "server-state-file-base".
9732
9733 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9734 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9735
9736 global
9737 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9738
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009739 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009740 load-server-state-from-file
9741
9742 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
9743 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009744
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009745server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9746 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9747 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9749 no | no | yes | yes
9750
9751 Arguments:
9752 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9753
9754 <num | range>
9755 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9756 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9757 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9758 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9759
9760 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9761
9762 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9763
9764 <params*>
9765 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9766 keyword.
9767
9768 Examples:
9769 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9770 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9771 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9772
9773 # or
9774 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9775
9776 # would be equivalent to:
9777 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9778 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9779 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9780
9781
9782
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009783source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009784source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009785source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009786 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9788 yes | no | yes | yes
9789 Arguments :
9790 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9791 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009792
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009793 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009794 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9795 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9796 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9797 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9798 supported prefixes are :
9799 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9800 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9801 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009802 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009803 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9804 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009805
9806 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9807 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009808 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9809 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9810 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009811
9812 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9813 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9814 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9815 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9816 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9817 <addr>.
9818
9819 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9820 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9821 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9822 port.
9823
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009824 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9825 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9826 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9827 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009828 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009829 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9830 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9831 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9832 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9833 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9834 HTTP header.
9835
9836 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9837 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009838 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009839 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9840 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9841 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9842 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9843 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9844 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9845 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9846
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009847 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9848 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9849 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9850 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9851 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9852 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9853
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009854 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9855 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9856 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9857 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9858
9859 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9860 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9861 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9862 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9863 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9864 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9865
9866 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9867 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9868 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9869 there are two methods :
9870
9871 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9872 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9873 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9874 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9875 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9876 of the client ranges may be used.
9877
9878 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9879 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9880 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9881 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9882 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9883 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9884 same session.
9885
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009886 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9887 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9888 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009889 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009890
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009891 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9892
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009893 Examples :
9894 backend private
9895 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9896 source 192.168.1.200
9897
9898 backend transparent_ssl1
9899 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9900 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9901
9902 backend transparent_ssl2
9903 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9904 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9905 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9906
9907 backend transparent_ssl3
9908 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9909 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9910 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9911
9912 backend transparent_smtp
9913 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9914 # with Tproxy version 4.
9915 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9916
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009917 backend transparent_http
9918 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9919 # proxy.
9920 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9921
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009922 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009923 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9924
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009925
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009926srvtcpka-cnt <count>
9927 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
9928 the connection on the server side.
9929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9930 yes | no | yes | yes
9931 Arguments :
9932 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
9933
9934 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
9935 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009936 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9937 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009938
9939 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9940
9941
9942srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
9943 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
9944 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
9945 server side.
9946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9947 yes | no | yes | yes
9948 Arguments :
9949 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
9950 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
9951 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
9952 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
9953
9954 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
9955 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009956 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9957 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009958
9959 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9960
9961
9962srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
9963 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
9964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9965 yes | no | yes | yes
9966 Arguments :
9967 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
9968 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
9969 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
9970 document.
9971
9972 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
9973 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009974 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9975 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009976
9977 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
9978
9979
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009980stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9981 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009983 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009984
9985 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9986 matched.
9987
9988 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9989 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9990
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009991 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9992 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009993 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009994
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009995 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9996 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9997 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9998 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009999
10000 Example :
10001 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10002 backend stats_localhost
10003 stats enable
10004 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10005
10006 Example :
10007 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10008 backend stats_auth
10009 stats enable
10010 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10011 stats admin if TRUE
10012
10013 Example :
10014 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10015 userlist stats-auth
10016 group admin users admin
10017 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10018 group readonly users haproxy
10019 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10020
10021 backend stats_auth
10022 stats enable
10023 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10024 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10025 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10026 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10027
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010028 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10029 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10030 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010031
10032
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010033stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10034 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010036 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010037 Arguments :
10038 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10039
10040 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10041
10042 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10043 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10044 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10045 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10046 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10047 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10048
10049 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10050 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10051 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010052 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010053
10054 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10055 report using "stats scope".
10056
10057 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10058 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10059 unobvious parameters.
10060
10061 Example :
10062 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10063 backend public_www
10064 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10065 stats enable
10066 stats hide-version
10067 stats scope .
10068 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010069 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010070 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10071 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10072
10073 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10074 backend private_monitoring
10075 stats enable
10076 stats uri /admin?stats
10077 stats refresh 5s
10078
10079 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10080
10081
10082stats enable
10083 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010085 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010086 Arguments : none
10087
10088 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10089 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10090 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10091 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10092 - stats auth : no authentication
10093 - stats scope : no restriction
10094
10095 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10096 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10097 unobvious parameters.
10098
10099 Example :
10100 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10101 backend public_www
10102 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10103 stats enable
10104 stats hide-version
10105 stats scope .
10106 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010107 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010108 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10109 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10110
10111 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10112 backend private_monitoring
10113 stats enable
10114 stats uri /admin?stats
10115 stats refresh 5s
10116
10117 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10118
10119
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010120stats hide-version
10121 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010123 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010124 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010125
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010126 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10127 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10128 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10129 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10130 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10131 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010132
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010133 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10134 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10135 unobvious parameters.
10136
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010137 Example :
10138 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10139 backend public_www
10140 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010141 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010142 stats hide-version
10143 stats scope .
10144 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010145 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010146 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10147 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010148
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010149 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10150 backend private_monitoring
10151 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010152 stats uri /admin?stats
10153 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010154
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010155 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010156
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010157
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010158stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10159 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10160 Access control for statistics
10161
10162 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10163 no | no | yes | yes
10164
10165 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10166 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10167 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10168 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10169 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10170 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10171
10172 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10173 instance.
10174
10175 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10176 about ACL usage.
10177
10178
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010179stats realm <realm>
10180 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10181 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010182 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010183 Arguments :
10184 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10185 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10186 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10187
10188 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10189 using a backslash ('\').
10190
10191 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10192 only related to authentication.
10193
10194 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10195 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10196 unobvious parameters.
10197
10198 Example :
10199 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10200 backend public_www
10201 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10202 stats enable
10203 stats hide-version
10204 stats scope .
10205 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010206 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010207 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10208 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10209
10210 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10211 backend private_monitoring
10212 stats enable
10213 stats uri /admin?stats
10214 stats refresh 5s
10215
10216 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10217
10218
10219stats refresh <delay>
10220 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010222 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010223 Arguments :
10224 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10225 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10226 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10227 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10228 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10229 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10230
10231 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10232 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10233 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010234 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010235
10236 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10237 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10238 unobvious parameters.
10239
10240 Example :
10241 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10242 backend public_www
10243 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10244 stats enable
10245 stats hide-version
10246 stats scope .
10247 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010248 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010249 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10250 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10251
10252 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10253 backend private_monitoring
10254 stats enable
10255 stats uri /admin?stats
10256 stats refresh 5s
10257
10258 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10259
10260
10261stats scope { <name> | "." }
10262 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010264 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010265 Arguments :
10266 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10267 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10268 section in which the statement appears.
10269
10270 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10271 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10272 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10273 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10274 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10275 exists.
10276
10277 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10278 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10279 unobvious parameters.
10280
10281 Example :
10282 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10283 backend public_www
10284 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10285 stats enable
10286 stats hide-version
10287 stats scope .
10288 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010289 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010290 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10291 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10292
10293 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10294 backend private_monitoring
10295 stats enable
10296 stats uri /admin?stats
10297 stats refresh 5s
10298
10299 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10300
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010301
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010302stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010303 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010305 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010306
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010307 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010308 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10309
10310 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10311 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10312
10313 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10314 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010315 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010316
10317 Example :
10318 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10319 backend private_monitoring
10320 stats enable
10321 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10322 stats uri /admin?stats
10323 stats refresh 5s
10324
10325 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10326 global section.
10327
10328
10329stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010330 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10331 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10332 yes | yes | yes | yes
10333 Arguments : none
10334
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010335 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010336 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10337 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10338 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10339 - IP (socket, server)
10340 - cookie (backend, server)
10341
10342 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10343 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010344 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010345
10346 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10347
10348
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010349stats show-modules
10350 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10352 yes | yes | yes | yes
10353 Arguments : none
10354
10355 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10356 values as a tooltip.
10357
10358 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10359 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10360 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10361
10362 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10363
10364
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010365stats show-node [ <name> ]
10366 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010368 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010369 Arguments:
10370 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10371 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10372
10373 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10374 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010375 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010376
10377 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10378 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10379 unobvious parameters.
10380
10381 Example:
10382 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10383 backend private_monitoring
10384 stats enable
10385 stats show-node Europe-1
10386 stats uri /admin?stats
10387 stats refresh 5s
10388
10389 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10390 section.
10391
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010392
10393stats uri <prefix>
10394 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010396 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010397 Arguments :
10398 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10399 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10400 query string.
10401
10402 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10403 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10404 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10405 possible to reach it in the application.
10406
10407 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010408 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010409 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10410 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10411 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10412 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10413
10414 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10415 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10416 an address or a port to statistics only.
10417
10418 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10419 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10420 unobvious parameters.
10421
10422 Example :
10423 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10424 backend public_www
10425 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10426 stats enable
10427 stats hide-version
10428 stats scope .
10429 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010430 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010431 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10432 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10433
10434 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10435 backend private_monitoring
10436 stats enable
10437 stats uri /admin?stats
10438 stats refresh 5s
10439
10440 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10441
10442
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010443stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10444 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010446 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010447
10448 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010449 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010450 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010451 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010452 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10453
10454 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10455 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10456 the "stick-table" statement.
10457
10458 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10459 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10460 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10461 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10462 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10463
10464 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10465 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10466 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10467 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10468 transformation rules.
10469
10470 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10471 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10472 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10473 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10474 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10475 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10476 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10477
10478 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10479 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10480 ACL based conditions.
10481
10482 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10483 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10484 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10485 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10486
10487 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10488 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10489 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10490 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10491
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010492 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10493 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010494 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010495
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010496 Example :
10497 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10498 # last 30 minutes
10499 backend pop
10500 mode tcp
10501 balance roundrobin
10502 stick store-request src
10503 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10504 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10505 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10506
10507 backend smtp
10508 mode tcp
10509 balance roundrobin
10510 stick match src table pop
10511 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10512 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10513
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010514 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010515 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010516
10517
10518stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10519 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10521 no | no | yes | yes
10522
10523 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10524 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10525 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10526 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10527
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010528 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10529 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010530 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010531
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010532 Examples :
10533 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010534 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010535
10536 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10537 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10538 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10539
10540
10541 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10542 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10543 backend http
10544 mode http
10545 balance roundrobin
10546 stick on src table https
10547 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10548 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10549 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10550
10551 backend https
10552 mode tcp
10553 balance roundrobin
10554 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10555 stick on src
10556 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10557 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10558
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010559 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010560
10561
10562stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10563 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
10564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10565 no | no | yes | yes
10566
10567 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010568 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010569 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010570 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010571 server is selected.
10572
10573 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10574 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10575 the "stick-table" statement.
10576
10577 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10578 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10579 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
10580 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
10581 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
10582 address.
10583
10584 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10585 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10586 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10587 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10588 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10589 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10590 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10591 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10592 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10593 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10594
10595 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10596 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10597 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10598 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10599 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10600 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10601 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10602
10603 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10604 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10605 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10606 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10607
10608 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10609 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10610 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10611 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10612 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10613 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010614 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10615 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10616 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10617 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10618 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10619 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010620
10621 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10622 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10623 the request.
10624
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010625 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10626 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010627 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010628
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010629 Example :
10630 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10631 # last 30 minutes
10632 backend pop
10633 mode tcp
10634 balance roundrobin
10635 stick store-request src
10636 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10637 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10638 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10639
10640 backend smtp
10641 mode tcp
10642 balance roundrobin
10643 stick match src table pop
10644 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10645 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10646
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010647 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010648 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010649
10650
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010651stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010652 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
10653 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010654 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010656 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010657
10658 Arguments :
10659 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10660 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10661 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10662 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10663
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010664 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10665 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10666 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10667 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10668
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010669 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10670 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10671 instance.
10672
10673 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10674 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10675 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10676 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10677 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10678 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010679 to 32 characters.
10680
10681 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10682 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10683 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010684 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010685 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10686 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010687
10688 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010689 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10690 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010691 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10692 increase.
10693
10694 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010695 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10696 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10697 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010698
10699 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10700 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10701 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10702 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010703 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010704 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10705 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10706 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10707 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10708 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10709 parameter (see below).
10710
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010711 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10712 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10713 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10714 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10715 soft restart.
10716
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010717 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10718 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010719
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010720 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10721 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10722 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10723 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010724 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010725 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010726 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10727 if not expiration delay is specified.
10728
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010729 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10730 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10731 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10732 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010733 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10734 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10735 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10736 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10737 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10738 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10739 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10740 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10741 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10742 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10743 types and their arguments.
10744
10745 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10746 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10747 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10748 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10749
10750 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10751 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10752 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010753 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010754
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010755 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10756 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10757 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010758 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010759 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010760 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010761
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010762 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10763 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10764 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10765 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10766
10767 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10768 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10769 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10770 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10771 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10772 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10773
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010774 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10775 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10776 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10777 they were received.
10778
10779 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10780 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10781 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10782 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10783 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10784
10785 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10786 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10787 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10788 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10789 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10790
10791 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10792 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10793 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10794
10795 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10796 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10797 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10798 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10799 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10800
10801 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10802 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10803 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10804 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10805 the client side.
10806
10807 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10808 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10809 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10810 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10811 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10812 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10813 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10814
10815 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10816 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10817 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10818 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10819 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10820 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010821 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010822
10823 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10824 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10825 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10826 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10827 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10828 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10829
10830 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010831 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010832 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10833 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10834
10835 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10836 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10837 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10838 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10839 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10840 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10841 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10842 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10843 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10844 recommended for better fairness.
10845
10846 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010847 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010848 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10849 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10850
10851 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10852 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10853 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10854 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10855 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10856 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10857 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10858 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10859 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10860 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010861
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010862 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10863 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010864 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10865 reference it.
10866
10867 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10868 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010869 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10870 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10871 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010872
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010873 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10874 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10875 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10876 something that can be ignored.
10877
10878 Example:
10879 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10880 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10881 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10882 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10883
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010884 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010885 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010886
10887
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010888stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010010889 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10891 no | no | yes | yes
10892
10893 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010894 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010895 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010896 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010897 server is selected.
10898
10899 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10900 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10901 the "stick-table" statement.
10902
10903 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10904 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10905 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10906 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10907
10908 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10909 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10910 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10911 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10912 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10913 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010914 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010915 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10916 rules.
10917
10918 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10919 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10920 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10921 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10922 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10923 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10924 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10925
10926 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10927 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10928 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10929 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10930
10931 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10932 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10933 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10934 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10935 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10936 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010937 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10938 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10939 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10940 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10941 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10942 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10943 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10944 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10945 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010946
10947 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10948
10949 Example :
10950 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10951 backend https
10952 mode tcp
10953 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010954 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010955 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010956
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010957 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10958 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10959
10960 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10961 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10962 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10963
10964 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10965 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010966
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010967 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10968 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10969 # at offset 44.
10970
10971 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10972 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10973
10974 # Learn on response if server hello.
10975 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010976
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010977 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10978 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10979
10980 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10981 extraction.
10982
10983
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010984tcp-check comment <string>
10985 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10986 it fails.
10987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10988 yes | no | yes | yes
10989
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010990 Arguments :
10991 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10992 rule fails.
10993
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010994 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10995 user-friendly error reporting.
10996
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010997 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10998 "tcp-check expect".
10999
11000
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011001tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11002 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011003 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011004 Opens a new connection
11005 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011006 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011007
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011008 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011009 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11010
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011011 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011012 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011013
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011014 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011015 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11016 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011017 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011018
11019 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011020
11021 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11022
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011023 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11024
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011025 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11026
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011027 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11028
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011029 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11030 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11031 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11032 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11033
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011034 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11035 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11036 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11037 haproxy -vv.
11038
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011039 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011040
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011041 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11042 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11043 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11044
11045 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11046 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11047 of the sequence.
11048
11049 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11050 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11051 do.
11052
11053 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11054 unset-var or comment rules.
11055
11056 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011057 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11058 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11059 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11060 option tcp-check
11061 tcp-check connect
11062 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11063 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11064 tcp-check send \r\n
11065 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11066 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11067 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11068 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11069 tcp-check send \r\n
11070 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11071 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11072
11073 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11074 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011075 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011076 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11077 tcp-check connect port 143
11078 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11079 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11080
11081 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11082
11083
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011084tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011085 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011086 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011087 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011088 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011089 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011090 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011091
11092 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011093 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11094
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011095 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11096 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11097 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11098 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11099 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11100 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11101 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11102 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11103 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11104 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11105
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011106 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011107 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11108 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011109 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11110 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11111 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11112
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011113 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11114 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11115 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011116 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11117 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011118 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11119 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011120 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11121 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011122 By default "L7OK" is used.
11123
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011124 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11125 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011126 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11127 supported :
11128 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11129 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011130 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11131 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11132 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11133 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11134 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011135
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011136 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011137 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011138 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11139 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11140 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11141 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011142 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11143
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011144 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11145 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11146 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11147 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11148
11149 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11150 informational message reported in logs if an error
11151 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11152 log-format string.
11153
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011154 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11155 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11156 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11157 followed by some converters.
11158
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011159 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11160 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11161 with the usual backslash ('\').
11162 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011163 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011164 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11165 used upper or lower case.
11166
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011167 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11168
11169 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11170 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11171 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11172 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11173 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11174 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11175 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11176 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11177
11178 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11179 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11180 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11181 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11182 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11183 expression.
11184
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011185 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11186 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11187 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11188 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11189 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11190 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11191
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011192 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11193 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11194 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11195 this exact hexadecimal string.
11196 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11197
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011198 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11199 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11200 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11201 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11202 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11203 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11204 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11205 size.
11206
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011207 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11208 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11209 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11210 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11211 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11212 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11213 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11214 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11215 in a binary string before matching the response's
11216 buffer.
11217
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011218 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011219 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011220 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11221 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11222 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11223 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11224 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11225 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11226 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11227 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11228 the null character.
11229
11230 Examples :
11231 # perform a POP check
11232 option tcp-check
11233 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11234
11235 # perform an IMAP check
11236 option tcp-check
11237 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11238
11239 # look for the redis master server
11240 option tcp-check
11241 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011242 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011243 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11244 tcp-check expect string role:master
11245 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11246 tcp-check expect string +OK
11247
11248
11249 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011250 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011251
11252
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011253tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11254tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11255 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11256 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011257 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011258 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011259
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011260 Arguments :
11261 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11262
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011263 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11264 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011265
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011266 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11267 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011268
11269 Examples :
11270 # look for the redis master server
11271 option tcp-check
11272 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11273 tcp-check expect string role:master
11274
11275 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011276 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011277
11278
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011279tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11280tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11281 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11282 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011283 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011284 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011285
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011286 Arguments :
11287 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011288
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011289 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11290 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011291
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011292 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11293 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11294 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011295
11296 Examples :
11297 # redis check in binary
11298 option tcp-check
11299 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11300 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11301
11302
11303 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011304 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011305
11306
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011307tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011308 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011309 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011310 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011311
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011312 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011313 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11314 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11315 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11316 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11317 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11318 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11319 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11320 and '-'.
11321
11322 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11323
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011324 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011325 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11326
11327
11328tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011329 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011330 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011331 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011332
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011333 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011334 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11335 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11336 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11337 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11338 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11339 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11340 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11341 and '-'.
11342
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011343 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011344 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11345
11346
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011347tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11348 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11350 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011351 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011352 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11353 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011354
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011355 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011356
11357 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11358 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011359 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11360 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11361 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11362 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11363 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11364 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011365
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011366 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11367 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11368 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11369 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011370
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011371 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011372 - accept :
11373 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11374 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11375 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011376
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011377 - reject :
11378 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11379 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11380 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11381 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11382 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11383 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11384 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11385 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11386 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11387 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11388 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011389 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011390
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011391 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11392 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11393 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11394 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11395 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11396 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11397 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11398 hosts.
11399
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011400 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11401 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11402 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11403 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11404 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11405 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11406 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11407 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11408
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011409 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11410 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11411 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11412 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11413 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11414 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11415 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11416 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11417 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011418 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11419 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011420
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011421 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011422 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011423 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11424 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11425 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011426 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011427 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011428 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11429 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11430 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11431 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11432 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11433 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11434 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011435
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011436 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011437 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011438 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011439 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011440 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11441 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11442 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011443
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011444 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11445 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11446 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11447 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011448
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011449 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11450 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11451 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11452 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11453 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011454 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11455 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11456 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11457 layer7 information is extracted.
11458
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011459 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11460 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11461 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11462 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11463 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011464
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011465 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11466 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11467 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11468 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11469
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011470 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11471 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11472 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11473 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11474
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011475 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11476 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11477 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11478 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11479 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011480
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011481 - set-src <expr> :
11482 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11483 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11484 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011485 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011486
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011487 Arguments:
11488 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11489 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011490
11491 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011492 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11493
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011494 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11495 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011496
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011497 - set-src-port <expr> :
11498 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11499 expression.
11500
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011501 Arguments:
11502 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11503 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011504
11505 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011506 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11507
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011508 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11509 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11510 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011511
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011512 - set-dst <expr> :
11513 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11514 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11515 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11516 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11517 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11518
11519 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11520 followed by some converters.
11521
11522 Example:
11523
11524 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11525 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11526
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011527 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
11528 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
11529
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011530 - set-dst-port <expr> :
11531 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
11532 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11533 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11534
11535
11536 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11537 followed by some converters.
11538
11539 Example:
11540
11541 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
11542
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011543 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
11544 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
11545 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
11546
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011547 - "silent-drop" :
11548 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011549 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011550 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11551 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11552 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11553 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11554 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011555 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11556 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011557 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11558 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011559 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011560 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11561 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11562 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11563 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11564
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011565 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11566 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11567 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011568
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011569 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11570 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
11571 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011572
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011573 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011574 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011575 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011576
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011577 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
11578 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11579 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011580
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011581 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011582 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11583 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011584
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011585 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
11586
11587 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11588
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011589 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11590
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011591 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011592
11593
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011594tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11595 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011597 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011598 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011599 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11600 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011601
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011602 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011603
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011604 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011605 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11606 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
11607 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
11608 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011609
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011610 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11611 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11612 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11613 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011614 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
11615 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
11616 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
11617 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
11618 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
11619 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011620 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011621 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011622
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011623 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11624 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11625 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11626 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011627
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011628 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011629 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011630 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011631 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11632 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011633 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011634 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011635 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011636 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011637 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011638 - set-dst <expr>
11639 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011640 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011641 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011642 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011643 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011644 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011645
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011646 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11647 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011648 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11649 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011650
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011651 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11652 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11653 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11654 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11655 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11656 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011657
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011658 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011659 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11660 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011661
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020011662 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
11663 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
11664 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
11665 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
11666 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
11667 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
11668
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011669 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020011670 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
11671 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
11672 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
11673 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
11674 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
11675 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
11676 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
11677 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
11678 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
11679 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011680
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011681 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011682 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11683 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11684 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011685
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011686 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11687 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11688
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011689 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011690 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11691 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011692
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011693 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11694 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011695 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011696 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11697 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011698 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011699 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011700 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011701 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11702 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011703 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011704 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11705 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011706
11707 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11708 followed by some converters.
11709
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011710 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11711 <var-name>.
11712
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011713 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11714 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11715 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11716 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11717 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11718
11719 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11720 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11721 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11722 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11723 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11724 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11725 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11726 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11727 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11728 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11729 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11730
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011731 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11732 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11733 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11734 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11735 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11736
11737 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11738
11739 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11740
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011741 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11742 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11743 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11744 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11745 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11746 evaluated.
11747
11748 Example:
11749 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11750
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011751 Example:
11752
11753 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011754 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011755
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011756 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011757 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11758 # and reject everything else.
11759 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11760 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011761 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011762 tcp-request content reject
11763
11764 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011765 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11766 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11767 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011768 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011769
11770 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11771 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11772 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011773 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011774 tcp-request content reject
11775
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011776 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011777 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011778 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011779 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011780 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11781 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011782
11783 Example:
11784 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11785 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011786 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011787
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011788 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011789 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011790
11791 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011792 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011793 # protecting all our sites
11794 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011795 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11796 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011797 ...
11798 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11799
11800 backend http_dynamic
11801 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011802 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011803 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011804 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011805 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011806 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011807 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011808
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011809 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011810
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011811 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11812 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011813
11814
11815tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11816 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011818 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011819 Arguments :
11820 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11821 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11822 as explained at the top of this document.
11823
11824 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11825 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11826 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11827 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11828 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11829
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011830 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11831 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11832 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11833 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11834
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011835 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11836 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011837 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011838 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011839 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11840 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11841 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11842 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011843
11844 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11845 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11846 it pass through unaffected.
11847
11848 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11849 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11850 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011851 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011852 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11853 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011854 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11855 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11856 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011857
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011858 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011859 "timeout client".
11860
11861
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011862tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11863 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11865 no | no | yes | yes
11866 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011867 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11868 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011869
11870 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11871
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011872 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011873 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11874 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011875 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11876 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011877
11878 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11879
11880 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11881 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11882 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11883 inserted.
11884
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011885 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011886 - accept :
11887 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11888 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11889 the rules evaluation.
11890
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011891 - close :
11892 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
11893 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
11894 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
11895 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
11896 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
11897 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011898 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011899 protocols.
11900
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011901 - reject :
11902 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11903 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011904 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011905
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011906 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11907 Sets a variable.
11908
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011909 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11910 Unsets a variable.
11911
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011912 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11913 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11914 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11915 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11916
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011917 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11918 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11919 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11920 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11921
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011922 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11923 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11924 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11925 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11926 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011927
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011928 - "silent-drop" :
11929 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011930 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011931 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11932 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11933 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11934 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11935 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011936 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11937 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011938 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11939 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011940 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011941 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11942 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11943 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11944 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11945
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011946 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11947 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11948
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011949 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11950 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11951 for changing the default action to a reject.
11952
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011953 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11954 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11955 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11956 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011957 period.
11958
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011959 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
11960 declared inline.
11961
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011962 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11963 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011964 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011965 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11966 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011967 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011968 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011969 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011970 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11971 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011972 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011973 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11974 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011975
11976 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11977 followed by some converters.
11978
11979 Example:
11980
11981 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
11982
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011983 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11984 <var-name>.
11985
11986 Example:
11987
11988 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
11989
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011990 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11991 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11992 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11993 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11994 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11995
11996 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11997
11998 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11999
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012000 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12001
12002 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12003
12004
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012005tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12006 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12008 no | yes | yes | no
12009 Arguments :
12010 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12011 below.
12012
12013 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12014
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012015 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012016 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12017 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12018 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12019 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12020 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12021 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12022 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012023 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012024 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12025 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12026 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12027 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12028 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12029 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12030 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12031 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12032 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12033 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12034 instead.
12035
12036 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12037 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12038 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12039 rules which may be inserted.
12040
12041 Several types of actions are supported :
12042 - accept : the request is accepted
12043 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12044 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12045 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012046 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012047 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012048 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012049 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012050 - silent-drop
12051
12052 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12053 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12054 sections for a complete description.
12055
12056 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12057 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12058 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12059
12060 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12061 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12062 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12063 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12064 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12065
12066 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12067 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12068
12069 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12070 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12071 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12072
12073 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12074 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12075 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12076
12077 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12078 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12079 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12080
12081 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12082 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12083 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12084
12085 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12086
12087 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12088
12089
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012090tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12091 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12093 no | no | yes | yes
12094 Arguments :
12095 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12096 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12097 as explained at the top of this document.
12098
12099 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12100
12101
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012102timeout check <timeout>
12103 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12104 established.
12105
12106 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12107 yes | no | yes | yes
12108 Arguments:
12109 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12110 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12111 as explained at the top of this document.
12112
12113 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
12114 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012115 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012116 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012117 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12118 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12119 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012120
12121 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
12122 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12123
12124 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12125 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012126 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012127
12128 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12129 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12130 forget about it.
12131
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012132 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12133 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012134
12135
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012136timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012137 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12139 yes | yes | yes | no
12140 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012141 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012142 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12143 as explained at the top of this document.
12144
12145 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12146 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12147 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012148 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12149 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12150 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12151 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012152 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12153 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12154 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012155 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012156 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012157 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12158 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012159 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12160 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012161
12162 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12163 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12164 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12165 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012166 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012167 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12168
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012169 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012170
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012171 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012172
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012173
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012174timeout client-fin <timeout>
12175 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12177 yes | yes | yes | no
12178 Arguments :
12179 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12180 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12181 as explained at the top of this document.
12182
12183 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12184 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12185 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12186 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12187 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12188 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12189 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012190 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12191 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12192 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012193
12194 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12195 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12196 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12197
12198 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12199
12200
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012201timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012202 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12204 yes | no | yes | yes
12205 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012206 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012207 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12208 as explained at the top of this document.
12209
12210 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012211 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012212 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012213 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012214 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12215 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012216
12217 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12218 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12219 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12220 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012221 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012222 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12223
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012224 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012225
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012226
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012227timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12228 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12230 yes | yes | yes | yes
12231 Arguments :
12232 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12233 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12234 as explained at the top of this document.
12235
12236 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12237 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12238 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12239 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12240 once the request has started to present itself.
12241
12242 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12243 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12244 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12245 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12246 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12247
12248 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12249 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12250 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12251 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12252
12253 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12254 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012255 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012256 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12257 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012258 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012259
12260 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12261 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12262 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12263 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12264
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012265 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12266 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012267 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12268
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012269 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12270
12271
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012272timeout http-request <timeout>
12273 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012275 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012276 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012277 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012278 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12279 as explained at the top of this document.
12280
12281 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12282 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12283 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12284 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12285 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12286 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12287 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012288 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12289 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12290 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12291 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012292 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012293 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12294 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012295
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012296 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12297 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12298 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12299 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12300 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012301 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012302
12303 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12304 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012305 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012306 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12307 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12308
12309 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012310 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12311 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12312 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012313
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012314 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012315 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012316
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012317
12318timeout queue <timeout>
12319 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12321 yes | no | yes | yes
12322 Arguments :
12323 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12324 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12325 as explained at the top of this document.
12326
12327 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12328 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12329 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12330 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12331 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12332
12333 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12334 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12335 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12336 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12337
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012338 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012339
12340
12341timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012342 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12344 yes | no | yes | yes
12345 Arguments :
12346 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12347 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12348 as explained at the top of this document.
12349
12350 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12351 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12352 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12353 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12354 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12355 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12356 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12357
12358 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12359 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12360 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12361 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12362 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012363 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012364 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012365 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12366 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012367 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12368 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012369
12370 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12371 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12372 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12373 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012374 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012375 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12376
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012377 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012378
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012379
12380timeout server-fin <timeout>
12381 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12383 yes | no | yes | yes
12384 Arguments :
12385 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12386 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12387 as explained at the top of this document.
12388
12389 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12390 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12391 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12392 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12393 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12394 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12395 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12396 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12397 situations, it should not be needed.
12398
12399 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12400 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12401 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12402
12403 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12404
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012405
12406timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012407 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12409 yes | yes | yes | yes
12410 Arguments :
12411 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12412 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12413 as explained at the top of this document.
12414
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012415 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12416 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12417 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012418
12419 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12420 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12421 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12422 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012423 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012424
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012425 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012426
12427
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012428timeout tunnel <timeout>
12429 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12431 yes | no | yes | yes
12432 Arguments :
12433 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12434 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12435 as explained at the top of this document.
12436
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012437 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012438 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12439 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12440 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012441 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12442 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012443 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12444 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12445 specified.
12446
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012447 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12448 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12449 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12450 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12451 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12452 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12453 state.
12454
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012455 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12456 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12457 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12458 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012459 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012460
12461 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12462 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12463 forget about it.
12464
12465 Example :
12466 defaults http
12467 option http-server-close
12468 timeout connect 5s
12469 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012470 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012471 timeout server 30s
12472 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12473
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012474 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012475
12476
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012477transparent (deprecated)
12478 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012480 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012481 Arguments : none
12482
12483 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12484 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12485 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12486 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12487 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12488 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12489 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12490 appropriate server.
12491
12492 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12493
12494 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12495 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12496
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012497 See also: "option transparent"
12498
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012499unique-id-format <string>
12500 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12502 yes | yes | yes | no
12503 Arguments :
12504 <string> is a log-format string.
12505
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012506 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
12507 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
12508 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
12509 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012510
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012511 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
12512 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
12513 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
12514 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
12515 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
12516 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
12517 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
12518 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012519
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012520 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
12521 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012522
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012523 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012524
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012525 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012526
12527 will generate:
12528
12529 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12530
12531 See also: "unique-id-header"
12532
12533unique-id-header <name>
12534 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
12535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12536 yes | yes | yes | no
12537 Arguments :
12538 <name> is the name of the header.
12539
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012540 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
12541 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012542
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012543 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012544
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012545 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012546 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
12547
12548 will generate:
12549
12550 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12551
12552 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012553
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012554use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012555 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12557 no | yes | yes | no
12558 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012559 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
12560 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012561
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012562 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
12563 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012564
12565 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
12566 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
12567 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012568 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012569 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012570 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
12571 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012572
12573 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
12574 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
12575 assign the backend.
12576
12577 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
12578 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12579 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
12580 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
12581 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
12582 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
12583
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012584 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012585 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012586 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
12587 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
12588 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
12589
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012590 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
12591 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
12592 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
12593 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
12594 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
12595 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
12596 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
12597 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
12598 cannot be forced from the request.
12599
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012600 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012601 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
12602 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
12603
12604 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
12605 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012606
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012607use-fcgi-app <name>
12608 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
12609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12610 no | no | yes | yes
12611 Arguments :
12612 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
12613
12614 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012615
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012616use-server <server> if <condition>
12617use-server <server> unless <condition>
12618 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
12619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12620 no | no | yes | yes
12621 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012622 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
12623 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012624
12625 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
12626
12627 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
12628 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
12629 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
12630
12631 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12632 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12633 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12634 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
12635 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
12636 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
12637 matches will assign the server.
12638
12639 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
12640 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12641 with the next rules until one matches.
12642
12643 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12644 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12645 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12646 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12647
12648 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12649 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12650 stripped.
12651
12652 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12653 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012654 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
12655 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
12656 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012657
12658 Example :
12659 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12660 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12661 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12662 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012663 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012664 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012665 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012666 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12667 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12668
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012669 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12670 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12671 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12672 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050012673 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012674 and we fall back to load balancing.
12675
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012676 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012677
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012678
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100126795. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012680--------------------------
12681
12682The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12683depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12684settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12685written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12686described in this section.
12687
12688
126895.1. Bind options
12690-----------------
12691
12692The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12693as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12694no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12695parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12696while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12697provided immediately after the setting name.
12698
12699The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12700
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012701accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12702 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12703 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12704 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12705 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12706 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12707 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12708 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12709 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12710 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012711 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12712 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12713 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012714
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012715accept-proxy
12716 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012717 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12718 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012719 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12720 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12721 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12722 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012723 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012724 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12725 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012726 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12727 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012728
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012729allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012730 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012731 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012732 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012733 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12734 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012735
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012736alpn <protocols>
12737 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12738 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12739 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012740 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012741 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012742 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12743 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12744 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12745 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12746 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12747 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12748 preference, like below :
12749
12750 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012751
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012752backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012753 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012754 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12755
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012756curves <curves>
12757 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12758 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12759 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12760 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12761 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12762 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12763
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012764ecdhe <named curve>
12765 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012766 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12767 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012768
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012769ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012770 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12771 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12772 client's certificate.
12773
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012774ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12775 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12776 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12777 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12778 error is ignored.
12779
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012780ca-sign-file <cafile>
12781 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12782 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12783 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12784 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12785 'generate-certificates' for details.
12786
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012787ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012788 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12789 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12790 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12791 'generate-certificates' for details.
12792
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012793ca-verify-file <cafile>
12794 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12795 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12796 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12797 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12798 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12799
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012800ciphers <ciphers>
12801 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12802 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012803 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012804 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012805 information and recommendations see e.g.
12806 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12807 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12808 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12809
12810ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12811 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12812 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12813 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12814 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012815 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12816 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012817
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012818crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012819 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12820 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12821 to verify client's certificate.
12822
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012823crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012824 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12825 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12826 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12827 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12828 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012829 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12830 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012831
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012832 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12833 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12834
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012835 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12836 are loaded.
12837
12838 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012839 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12840 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12841 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12842 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12843 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12844 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12845 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012846 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012847
12848 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12849 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12850 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12851 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012852 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12853 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012854
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012855 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012856
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012857 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012858 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012859 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12860 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012861 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12862 clients).
12863
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012864 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12865 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12866 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12867 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12868 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12869 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12870 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12871 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12872 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12873 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12874 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12875 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12876 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12877
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012878 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12879 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12880 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
12881 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
12882 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
12883
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012884 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
12885 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
12886 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
12887 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012888
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012889 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
12890 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
12891 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012892
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012893crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012894 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012895 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012896 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012897 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012898
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012899crt-list <file>
12900 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012901 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12902 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012903
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012904 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12905
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020012906 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12907 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
12908 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
12909 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
12910 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012911
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012912 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012913 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
12914 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
12915 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
12916 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
12917 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012918 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12919 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12920 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012921
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012922 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
12923 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
12924 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012925
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012926 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
12927
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030012928 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
12929 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which haproxy should use in
12930 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
12931 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
12932 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
12933 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
12934 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
12935 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012936
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012937 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012938 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012939 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012940 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012941 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012942 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012943
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012944defer-accept
12945 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12946 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12947 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012948 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012949 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12950 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12951 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12952 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12953 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12954 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12955 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12956
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012957expose-fd listeners
12958 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12959 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012960 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12961 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012962 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012963
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012964force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012965 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012966 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012967 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012968 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012969
12970force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012971 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012972 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012973 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012974
12975force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012976 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012977 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012978 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012979
12980force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012981 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012982 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012983 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012984
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012985force-tlsv13
12986 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12987 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012988 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012989
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012990generate-certificates
12991 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12992 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12993 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12994 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12995 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12996 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12997 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12998 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12999 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13000 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13001 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13002
13003 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13004 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013005 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013006 certificate is used many times.
13007
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013008gid <gid>
13009 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13010 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13011 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13012 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13013 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13014
13015group <group>
13016 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13017 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13018 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13019 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13020 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13021
13022id <id>
13023 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13024 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13025 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13026 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13027
13028interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013029 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13030 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13031 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13032 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13033 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13034 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013035 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13036 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13037 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13038 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13039 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13040 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013041
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013042level <level>
13043 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13044 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13045 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013046 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013047 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13048 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13049 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013050 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013051 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013052 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013053 all counters).
13054
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013055severity-output <format>
13056 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13057 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13058 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13059 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13060 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13061 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13062 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13063 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13064 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13065 rfc5424 convention.
13066
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013067maxconn <maxconn>
13068 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13069 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13070 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13071 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13072 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13073 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13074 eat all memory.
13075
13076mode <mode>
13077 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13078 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13079 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13080 UNIX sockets.
13081
13082mss <maxseg>
13083 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13084 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13085 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13086 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13087 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13088 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13089 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13090 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13091 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13092 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13093 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13094
13095name <name>
13096 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13097 page.
13098
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013099namespace <name>
13100 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13101 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13102 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13103 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13104
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013105nice <nice>
13106 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13107 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13108 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13109 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13110 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13111 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13112 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13113 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13114 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13115 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13116 one for an RDP socket.
13117
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013118no-ca-names
13119 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13120 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013121 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013122
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013123no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013124 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013125 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013126 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013127 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013128 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13129 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013130
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013131no-tls-tickets
13132 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13133 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13134 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013135 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13136 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013137 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13138 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13139 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013140
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013141no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013142 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013143 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013144 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013145 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013146 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13147 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013148
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013149no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013150 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013151 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013152 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013153 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013154 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13155 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013156
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013157no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013158 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013159 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013160 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013161 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013162 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13163 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013164
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013165no-tlsv13
13166 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13167 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13168 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13169 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013170 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13171 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013172
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013173npn <protocols>
13174 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13175 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13176 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013177 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013178 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013179 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13180 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13181 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13182 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13183 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013184
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013185prefer-client-ciphers
13186 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13187 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13188 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013189 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13190 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13191 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013192
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013193process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013194 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013195 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013196 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013197 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13198 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13199 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13200 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013201 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013202 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13203 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13204 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13205 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13206 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013207
13208 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13209
13210 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13211 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13212 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13213 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13214 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13215 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13216 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13217 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013218
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013219proto <name>
13220 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13221 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13222 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
13223 in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013224 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013225 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013226 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013227 h2" on the bind line.
13228
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013229ssl
13230 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013231 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013232 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13233 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013234 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13235 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013236
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013237ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13238 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013239 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13240 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13241 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013242 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13243
13244ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013245 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13246 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13247 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13248 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013249
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013250strict-sni
13251 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13252 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13253 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13254 See the "crt" option for more information.
13255
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013256tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013257 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013258 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
13259 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013260 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013261 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13262 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13263 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13264 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13265 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13266 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13267 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13268
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013269tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013270 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013271 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13272 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13273 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13274 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13275 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13276 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13277 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013278 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13279 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13280 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013281
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013282tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13283 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013284 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13285 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13286 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13287 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13288 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13289 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13290 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13291 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13292 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13293 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013294 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13295 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13296
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013297transparent
13298 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13299 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13300 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13301 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13302 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13303 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13304 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13305 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13306 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13307 so check for support with your vendor.
13308
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013309v4v6
13310 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13311 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13312 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13313 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013314 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013315
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013316v6only
13317 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13318 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13319 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013320 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13321 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013322
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013323uid <uid>
13324 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13325 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13326 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13327 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13328 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13329
13330user <user>
13331 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13332 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13333 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13334 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13335 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13336
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013337verify [none|optional|required]
13338 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13339 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13340 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13341 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13342 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013343 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13344 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13345 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13346 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013347
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200133485.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013349------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013350
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013351The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13352which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13353arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13354settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13355after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13356Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13357address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013359 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013360 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013361
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013362Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13363keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13364
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013365The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013366
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013367addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013368 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013369 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13370 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13371 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13372 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13373 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013374
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013375agent-check
13376 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013377 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013378 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13379 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13380 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013381
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013382 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013383 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013384 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13385 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13386 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013387
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013388 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13389 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13390 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13391 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13392 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013393
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013394 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013395 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013396
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013397 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13398 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13399 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013400
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013401 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13402 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13403 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013404
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013405 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013406 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13407 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13408 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13409 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013410 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013411 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013412
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013413 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13414 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013415
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013416 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13417 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13418 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13419 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13420 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13421 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13422 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13423 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13424 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013425
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013426 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13427 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013428 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13429 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13430 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013431 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013432
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013433 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013434 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013435
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013436agent-send <string>
13437 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13438 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13439 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13440 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13441 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13442
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013443agent-inter <delay>
13444 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13445 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13446
13447 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13448 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13449 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13450 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13451 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13452 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13453 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13454 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13455 of backends use the same servers.
13456
13457 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13458
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013459agent-addr <addr>
13460 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13461
13462 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13463 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13464 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13465 hostname, it will be resolved.
13466
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013467agent-port <port>
13468 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13469
13470 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13471
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013472allow-0rtt
13473 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013474 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13475 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013476
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013477alpn <protocols>
13478 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13479 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13480 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013481 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013482 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13483 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13484 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13485 now obsolete NPN extension.
13486 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13487 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13488
13489 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13490
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013491backup
13492 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
13493 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
13494 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
13495 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013496 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
13497 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013498
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013499ca-file <cafile>
13500 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13501 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13502 server's certificate.
13503
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013504check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013505 This option enables health checks on a server:
13506 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
13507 considered available.
13508 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
13509 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
13510 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
13511 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
13512 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
13513 set.
13514 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
13515 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
13516 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
13517 exchanges succeed.
13518
13519 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
13520 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
13521 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
13522 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
13523 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050013524 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013525 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
13526
13527 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
13528 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
13529
13530 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
13531 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
13532
13533 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
13534 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
13535 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
13536 available.
13537
13538 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
13539 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
13540 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
13541
13542 Example:
13543 # simple tcp check
13544 backend foo
13545 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
13546 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
13547 backend foo
13548 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
13549 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
13550 backend foo
13551 option tcp-check
13552 tcp-check connect
13553 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013554
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020013555check-send-proxy
13556 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
13557 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
13558 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
13559 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
13560 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
13561 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
13562 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
13563
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010013564check-alpn <protocols>
13565 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13566 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13567 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13568
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013569check-proto <name>
13570 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13571 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13572 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
13573 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013574 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013575 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
13576 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
13577
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013578check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013579 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013580 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
13581 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013582
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013583check-ssl
13584 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
13585 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
13586 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
13587 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013588 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013589 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
13590 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013591 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013592 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
13593 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013594
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013595check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013596 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013597 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13598 for normal traffic.
13599
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013600ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013601 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13602 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13603 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013604 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13605 information and recommendations see e.g.
13606 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13607 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13608 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013609
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013610ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13611 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13612 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13613 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13614 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013615 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13616 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13617 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013618
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013619cookie <value>
13620 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13621 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13622 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13623 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13624 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13625 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13626 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13627
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013628crl-file <crlfile>
13629 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13630 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13631 to verify server's certificate.
13632
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013633crt <cert>
13634 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13635 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13636 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13637 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13638 certificate request.
13639
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013640disabled
13641 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13642 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13643 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13644 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13645 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013646 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013647
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013648enabled
13649 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13650 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13651 default value.
13652 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13653 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013654
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013655error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013656 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13657 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13658 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013659
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013660 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013661
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013662fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013663 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13664 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13665 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13666
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013667force-sslv3
13668 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13669 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013670 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013671 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013672
13673force-tlsv10
13674 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013675 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013676 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013677
13678force-tlsv11
13679 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013680 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013681 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013682
13683force-tlsv12
13684 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013685 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013686 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013687
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013688force-tlsv13
13689 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13690 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013691 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013692
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013693id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013694 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13695 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13696 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013697
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013698init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13699 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13700 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013701 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013702 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13703 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13704 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13705 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13706 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13707 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13708 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13709 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13710 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013711 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013712 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13713 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13714 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13715 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13716 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13717 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013718 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013719
13720 Example:
13721 defaults
13722 # never fail on address resolution
13723 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13724
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013725inter <delay>
13726fastinter <delay>
13727downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013728 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13729 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13730 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13731 between checks depending on the server state :
13732
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013733 Server state | Interval used
13734 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13735 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13736 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13737 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13738 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13739 or yet unchecked. |
13740 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13741 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13742 | "inter" otherwise.
13743 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013744
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013745 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13746 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13747 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13748 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013749 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13750 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13751 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13752 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13753 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013754
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013755log-proto <logproto>
13756 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13757 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13758 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13759 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13760
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013761maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013762 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13763 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013764 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13765 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013766 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13767 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13768 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13769 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13770
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013771 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13772 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13773 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13774 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13775 than 50 concurrent requests.
13776
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013777maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013778 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13779 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13780 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13781 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020013782 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
13783 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
13784 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
13785 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
13786 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
13787 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
13788 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013789
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013790max-reuse <count>
13791 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13792 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13793 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13794 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13795 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13796 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13797 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13798 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13799
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013800minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013801 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13802 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13803 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13804 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13805 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13806 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013807 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013808 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013809
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013810namespace <name>
13811 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13812 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13813 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13814 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13815
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013816no-agent-check
13817 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13818 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13819 default value.
13820 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13821 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13822
13823no-backup
13824 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13825 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13826 default value.
13827 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13828 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13829
13830no-check
13831 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13832 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13833 default value.
13834 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13835 "default-server" "check" setting.
13836
13837no-check-ssl
13838 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13839 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13840 default value.
13841 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13842 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13843
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013844no-send-proxy
13845 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13846 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13847 default value.
13848 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13849 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13850
13851no-send-proxy-v2
13852 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13853 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13854 default value.
13855 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13856 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13857
13858no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13859 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13860 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13861 default value.
13862 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13863 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13864
13865no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13866 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13867 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13868 default value.
13869 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13870 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13871
13872no-ssl
13873 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13874 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13875 default value.
13876 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13877 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13878
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010013879 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
13880 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
13881 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
13882
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013883no-ssl-reuse
13884 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13885 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13886 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13887 and for paranoid users.
13888
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013889no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013890 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13891 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013892 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013893
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013894 Supported in default-server: No
13895
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013896no-tls-tickets
13897 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13898 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13899 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013900 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13901 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013902 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13903 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13904 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013905 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013906
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013907no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013908 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013909 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13910 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013911 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13912 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013913 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013914
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013915 Supported in default-server: No
13916
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013917no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013918 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013919 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13920 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013921 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13922 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013923 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013924
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013925 Supported in default-server: No
13926
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013927no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013928 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013929 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13930 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013931 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13932 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013933 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013934
13935 Supported in default-server: No
13936
13937no-tlsv13
13938 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13939 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13940 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13941 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13942 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013943 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013944
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013945 Supported in default-server: No
13946
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013947no-verifyhost
13948 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13949 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13950 default value.
13951 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13952 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013953
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013954no-tfo
13955 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13956 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13957 default value.
13958 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13959 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13960
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013961non-stick
13962 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13963 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13964 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13965
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013966npn <protocols>
13967 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13968 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13969 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013970 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013971 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13972 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13973 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13974
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013975observe <mode>
13976 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
13977 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
13978 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
13979 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
13980 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
13981 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010013982 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013983
13984 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13985
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013986on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013987 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13988 Currently, four modes are available:
13989 - fastinter: force fastinter
13990 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13991 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13992 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13993 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13994
13995 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13996
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013997on-marked-down <action>
13998 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13999 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014000 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14001 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14002 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14003 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14004 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14005 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14006 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14007 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014008
14009 Actions are disabled by default
14010
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014011on-marked-up <action>
14012 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14013 Currently one action is available:
14014 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14015 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14016 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14017 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014018 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14019 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014020 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14021 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14022
14023 Actions are disabled by default
14024
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014025pool-low-conn <max>
14026 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14027 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14028 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14029 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14030 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14031 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14032 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14033 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14034 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14035 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
14036 applying to "http-reuse".
14037
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014038pool-max-conn <max>
14039 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14040 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14041 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14042 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14043 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14044 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14045
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014046pool-purge-delay <delay>
14047 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014048 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014049 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014050
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014051port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014052 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
14053 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
14054 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
14055 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
14056 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
14057 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
14058
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014059proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014060 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14061 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14062 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
14063 reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014064 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014065 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14066
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014067redir <prefix>
14068 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14069 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14070 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14071 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14072 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14073 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14074 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14075 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014076 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014077 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014078 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14079 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14080 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14081 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14082
14083 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14084
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014085rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014086 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14087 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14088 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14089
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014090resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14091 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14092 server.
14093
14094 Available options:
14095
14096 * allow-dup-ip
14097 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14098 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14099 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14100 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14101 For such case, simply enable this option.
14102 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14103
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014104 * ignore-weight
14105 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14106 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14107 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14108
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014109 * prevent-dup-ip
14110 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14111 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14112 same fqdn.
14113 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14114
14115 Example:
14116 backend b_myapp
14117 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14118 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14119 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14120
14121 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14122 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14123 it
14124 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14125 different address
14126
14127 Default value: not set
14128
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014129resolve-prefer <family>
14130 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14131 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14132 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14133 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14134
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014135 Default value: ipv6
14136
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014137 Example:
14138
14139 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014140
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014141resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014142 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014143 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014144 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014145 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14146 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014147 configured network, another address is selected.
14148
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014149 Example:
14150
14151 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014152
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014153resolvers <id>
14154 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14155 hostname.
14156
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014157 Example:
14158
14159 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014160
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014161 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014162
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014163send-proxy
14164 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14165 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14166 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14167 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014168 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14169 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14170 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14171 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
14172 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
14173 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14174 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14175 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14176 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14177 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014178 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14179 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014180
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014181send-proxy-v2
14182 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14183 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14184 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14185 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014186 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14187 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14188 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14189 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014190
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014191proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014192 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14193 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14194
14195 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14196 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14197 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14198 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14199 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14200 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14201 connection is supported).
14202 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14203 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14204 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14205 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14206 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14207 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14208 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014209
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014210send-proxy-v2-ssl
14211 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14212 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14213 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14214 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14215 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14216 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14217 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014218 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14219 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014220
14221send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14222 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14223 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14224 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14225 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14226 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14227 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14228 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14229 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014230 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14231 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014232
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014233slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014234 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14235 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14236 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14237 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14238 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14239 parameters :
14240
14241 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14242 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14243
14244 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14245 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14246 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14247 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14248
14249 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
14250 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14251 seen as failed.
14252
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014253sni <expression>
14254 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14255 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14256 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14257 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014258 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14259 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014260 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014261 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14262 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014263
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014264source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014265source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014266source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014267 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14268 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14269 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14270 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14271
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014272 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14273 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14274 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14275 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14276 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
14277 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
14278 server.
14279
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000014280 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
14281 specifying the source address without port(s).
14282
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014283ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020014284 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
14285 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
14286 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
14287 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
14288 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
14289 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014290 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
14291 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014292
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014293ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14294 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
14295 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14296 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14297
14298ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14299 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
14300 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14301 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
14302
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014303ssl-reuse
14304 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
14305 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14306 default value.
14307 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14308 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
14309
14310stick
14311 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
14312 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14313 default value.
14314 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14315 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014316
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014317socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014318 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014319 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
14320 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
14321
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014322tcp-ut <delay>
14323 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
14324 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
14325 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014326 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014327 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14328 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14329 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14330 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14331 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14332 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14333 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14334 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14335 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14336
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014337tfo
14338 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14339 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14340 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14341 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14342 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014343 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014345track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014346 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14347 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14348 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14349 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014350 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14351
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014352tls-tickets
14353 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14354 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14355 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014356 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14357 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14358 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014359 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014360 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014361
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014362verify [none|required]
14363 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014364 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014365 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14366 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014367 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014368 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14369 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14370 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14371 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14372 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14373 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14374 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14375 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014376
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014377verifyhost <hostname>
14378 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014379 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14380 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14381 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14382 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14383 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14384 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14385 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14386 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014387
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014388weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014389 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14390 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14391 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014392 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14393 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14394 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14395 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14396 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14397 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014398
14399
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200144005.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14401-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014402
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014403HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14404using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
14405configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014406This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14407can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14408workload.
14409This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14410resolution at run time.
14411Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14412carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14413
14414
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200144155.3.1. Global overview
14416----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014417
14418As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14419different steps of the process life:
14420
14421 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14422 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14423 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14424
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014425 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14426 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014427
14428A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14429 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14430 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14431 resolution to know this new IP.
14432
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014433When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014434HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014435SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14436from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14437will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14438will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014439
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014440A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014441 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014442 first valid response.
14443
14444 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14445 servers return an error.
14446
14447
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200144485.3.2. The resolvers section
14449----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014450
14451This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014452HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
14453contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014454
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014455When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
14456uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
14457is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
14458answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
14459
14460When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014461used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014462
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014463 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
14464 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
14465 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014466
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014467 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
14468 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014469
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014470 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
14471 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
14472 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014473
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014474For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
14475following scenarios are possible:
14476
14477 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
14478 ignored
14479
14480 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
14481 applied
14482
14483 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
14484 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
14485
14486 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
14487 retries the query with a new type
14488
14489 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
14490 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014491
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014492As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
14493a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014494<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014495
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014496
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014497resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014498 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014499
14500A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
14501
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014502accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014503 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014504 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014505 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
14506 by RFC 6891)
14507
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020014508 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
14509
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014510nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
14511 DNS server description:
14512 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
14513 <ip> : IP address of the server
14514 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
14515
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014516parse-resolv-conf
14517 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
14518 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
14519 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
14520
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014521hold <status> <period>
14522 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
14523 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014524 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014525 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014526 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
14527 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14528 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
14529
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020014530 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014531
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014532resolve_retries <nb>
14533 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
14534 giving up.
14535 Default value: 3
14536
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014537 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
14538 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
14539 type.
14540
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014541timeout <event> <time>
14542 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
14543 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
14544 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014545 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
14546 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014547 Default value: 1s
14548 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014549 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014550 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014551 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14552 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
14553
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014554 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014555
14556 resolvers mydns
14557 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
14558 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014559 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014560 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014561 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014562 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014563 hold other 30s
14564 hold refused 30s
14565 hold nx 30s
14566 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014567 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014568 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014569
14570
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200145716. Cache
14572---------
14573
14574HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
14575(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
14576RAM.
14577
14578The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
14579this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
14580
14581If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
14582independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
14583when we try to allocate a new one.
14584
14585The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
14586
14587It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
14588"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
14589for more details.
14590
14591When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
14592replaced by "<CACHE>".
14593
14594
145956.1. Limitation
14596----------------
14597
14598The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
14599
14600- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010014601- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
14602 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
14603 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014604- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
14605- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010014606- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
14607 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
14608 headers)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014609
14610- If the request is not a GET
14611- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
14612- If the request contains an Authorization header
14613
14614
146156.2. Setup
14616-----------
14617
14618To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
14619the corresponding http-request and response actions.
14620
14621
146226.2.1. Cache section
14623---------------------
14624
14625cache <name>
14626 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
14627 size of cache is mandatory.
14628
14629total-max-size <megabytes>
14630 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
14631 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
14632
14633max-object-size <bytes>
14634 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
14635 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
14636 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
14637
14638max-age <seconds>
14639 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
14640 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
14641 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
14642 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
14643 default.
14644
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010014645process-vary <0 or 1>
14646 Disable or enable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
14647 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
14648 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
14649 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
14650 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is 0 (disabled).
14651
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014652
146536.2.2. Proxy section
14654---------------------
14655
14656http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14657 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
14658 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
14659 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
14660 after this one.
14661
14662http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14663 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
14664 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
14665 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
14666 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
14667
14668
14669Example:
14670
14671 backend bck1
14672 mode http
14673
14674 http-request cache-use foobar
14675 http-response cache-store foobar
14676 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
14677
14678 cache foobar
14679 total-max-size 4
14680 max-age 240
14681
14682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146837. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14684----------------------------------
14685
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014686HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014687client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14688The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14689these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14690but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14691data called patterns.
14692
14693
146947.1. ACL basics
14695---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014696
14697The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14698content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14699from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14700simple :
14701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014702 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014703 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014704 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14705 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014707The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14708adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014709
14710In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014712 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014713
14714This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14715Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14716and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014717an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14718conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14719as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14720are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014721
14722ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14723'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14724which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14725
14726There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14727performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014729The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14730specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14731this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014732methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14733ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014734
14735Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14736 - boolean
14737 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14738 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14739 - string
14740 - data block
14741
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014742Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14743converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14744would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14745The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14746which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14747
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014748Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14749keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14750fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14751which are summarized in the table below :
14752
14753 +---------------------+-----------------+
14754 | Sample or converter | Default |
14755 | output type | matching method |
14756 +---------------------+-----------------+
14757 | boolean | bool |
14758 +---------------------+-----------------+
14759 | integer | int |
14760 +---------------------+-----------------+
14761 | ip | ip |
14762 +---------------------+-----------------+
14763 | string | str |
14764 +---------------------+-----------------+
14765 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14766 +---------------------+-----------------+
14767
14768Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14769matching method, see below.
14770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014771The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14772 - boolean
14773 - integer or integer range
14774 - IP address / network
14775 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14776 - regular expression
14777 - hex block
14778
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014779The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14780
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014781 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14782 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014783 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014784 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014785 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014786 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014787 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014789The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14790read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14791if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14792lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14793will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14794beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14795a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14796lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14797exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14798
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014799The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14800parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14801ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14802a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14803check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14804
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014805The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14806socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14807file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014809Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14810loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14811
14812 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14813
14814In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14815the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14816case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14817as well.
14818
14819The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14820sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14821do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14822methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14823is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014824obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014825followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14826default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14827that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14828string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14829
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014830The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14831By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14832string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14833resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14834server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014835waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014836flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14837function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014839There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14840sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14841be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014842
14843 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14844 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014845 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14846 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14847 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14848 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014849
14850 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14851 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014852 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014853
14854 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014855 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014856
14857 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014858 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014859
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014860 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014861 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
14862
14863 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
14864 binary or string samples.
14865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014866 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
14867 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014869 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
14870 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
14871 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014873 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
14874 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014876 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
14877 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014879 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
14880 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014882 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
14883 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014884 This may be used with binary or string samples.
14885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014886 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
14887 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
14888 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014889
14890For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
14891request, it is possible to do :
14892
14893 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
14894
14895In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
14896buffer, one would use the following acl :
14897
14898 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
14899
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014900On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
14901possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
14902
14903 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
14904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014905All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
14906criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
14907method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
14908to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
14909criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
14910the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014912If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014913the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
14914For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014916 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
14917 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
14918 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
14919 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014920
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014921
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014922The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14923types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14924combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14925brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14926default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014928 +-------------------------------------------------+
14929 | Input sample type |
14930 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014931 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014932 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14933 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14934 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014935 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014936 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014937 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014938 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014939 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014940 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014941 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014942 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014943 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014944 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014945 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014946 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014947 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014948 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014949 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014950 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014951 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014952 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014953 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014954 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014955 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014956 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14957 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
14958 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014959
14960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149617.1.1. Matching booleans
14962------------------------
14963
14964In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
14965Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
14966When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
14967that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
14968
14969Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
14970return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
14971"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
14972
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149747.1.2. Matching integers
14975------------------------
14976
14977Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
14978enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
14979to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
14980
14981Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
14982matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
14983lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014984
14985For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
14986unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
14987representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
14988
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014989As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
14990two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
14991instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
14992ranges and operators.
14993
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014994For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014995operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
14996Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
14997of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014998
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014999Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015000
15001 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15002 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15003 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15004 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15005 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15006
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015007For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015008
15009 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
15010
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015011This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15012
15013 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
15014
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200150167.1.3. Matching strings
15017-----------------------
15018
15019String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15020different forms :
15021
15022 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015023 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015024
15025 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015026 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015027
15028 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15029 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15030
15031 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15032 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15033
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015034 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015035 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15036 matches.
15037
15038 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15039 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15040 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015041
15042String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15043exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15044characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15045string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15046to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015047before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015048
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015049Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15050(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15051Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15052
15053Example:
15054 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15055 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15056
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200150587.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15059---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015060
15061Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15062they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15063possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15064passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15065the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015066the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15067match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015068
15069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200150707.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15071-------------------------------------
15072
15073It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15074not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15075a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15076to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15077digits may be used upper or lower case.
15078
15079Example :
15080 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15081 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15082
15083
150847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15085---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015086
15087IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15088netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15089within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015090host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015091difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15092at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15093does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15094parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015095
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015096The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15097abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15098
15099 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15100 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15101 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15102 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15103 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15104 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15105 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15106 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15107
15108Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15109192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15110
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015111IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15112Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15113trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15114IPv6 patterns.
15115
15116HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15117following situations :
15118 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15119 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15120 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15121 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15122 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15123 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15124 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15125 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15126 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15127 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015129
151307.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15131----------------------------------
15132
15133Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15134combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15135
15136 - AND (implicit)
15137 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15138 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015140A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015142 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015144Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15145indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015147For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15148"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15149requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15150is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15151
15152 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015153 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15154 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15155 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015156
15157To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15158and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15159
15160 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15161 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15162 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15163 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15164
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015165 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015166 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15167 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15168 use_backend www if host_www
15169
15170It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15171expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15172be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15173the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15174
15175 The following rule :
15176
15177 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015178 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015179
15180 Can also be written that way :
15181
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015182 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015183
15184It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15185to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15186simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15187sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15188good use is the following :
15189
15190 With named ACLs :
15191
15192 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15193 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15194 monitor fail if site_dead
15195
15196 With anonymous ACLs :
15197
15198 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15199
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015200See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15201keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015202
15203
152047.3. Fetching samples
15205---------------------
15206
15207Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15208against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15209sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15210ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15211of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15212available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15213
15214This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15215Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15216compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15217deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15218
15219The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15220matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15221method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15222indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15223
15224As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15225when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15226mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15227the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15228ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15229
15230Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15231multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15232when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015233incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15234are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015235is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15236all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15237
15238Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15239 - name
15240 - name(arg1)
15241 - name(arg1,arg2)
15242
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015243
152447.3.1. Converters
15245-----------------
15246
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015247Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15248of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15249is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
15250was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015251has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015252unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
15253
15254These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
15255sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
15256the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015257support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015258
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015259A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
15260support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
15261supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
15262(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
15263bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
15264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015265The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015266
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001526751d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
15268 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15269 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15270 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
15271 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15272 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15273
15274 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015275 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
15276 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000015277 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
15278 frontend http-in
15279 bind *:8081
15280 default_backend servers
15281 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15282 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15283
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015284add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015285 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015286 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015287 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
15288 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015289 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015290 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15291 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15292 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15293 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015294 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015295 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015296
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010015297aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
15298 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
15299 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
15300 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
15301 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
15302 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
15303 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
15304
15305 Example:
15306 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
15307 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
15308
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015309and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015310 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015311 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015312 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15313 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015314 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015315 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15316 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15317 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15318 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015319 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015320 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015321
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015322b64dec
15323 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
15324 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
15325
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015326base64
15327 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015328 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015329 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
15330
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015331bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015332 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015333 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015334 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015335 presence of a flag).
15336
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015337bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
15338 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
15339 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015340 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015341
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015342concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
15343 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
15344 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
15345 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
15346 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
15347 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
15348 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15349 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15350 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15351 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15352 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015353 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015354 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015355 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15356 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015357
15358 Example:
15359 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15360 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15361 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015362 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015363 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15364
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015365cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015366 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15367 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015368
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015369crc32([<avalanche>])
15370 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15371 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15372 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15373 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15374 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15375 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15376 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15377 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15378 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15379 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015380 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15381
15382crc32c([<avalanche>])
15383 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15384 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15385 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15386 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15387 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15388 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15389 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15390 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015391
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015392cut_crlf
15393 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15394 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15395 updated.
15396
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015397da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015398 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15399 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15400 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15401 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015402 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015403 configuration language.
15404
15405 Example:
15406 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015407 bind *:8881
15408 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015409 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015410
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015411debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15412 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15413 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15414 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15415 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15416 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15417 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15418 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15419 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15420 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15421 printable sample types.
15422
15423 Example:
15424 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020015425
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015426digest(<algorithm>)
15427 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
15428 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
15429
15430 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15431 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15432
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015433div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015434 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15435 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015436 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015437 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
15438 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015439 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015440 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15441 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15442 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15443 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015444 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015445 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015446
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015447djb2([<avalanche>])
15448 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
15449 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15450 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15451 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15452 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15453 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15454 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015455 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
15456 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015457
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015458even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015459 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015460 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
15461
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015462field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15463 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
15464 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
15465 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
15466 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
15467 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
15468 fields.
15469
15470 Example :
15471 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
15472 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15473 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
15474 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
15475 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010015476
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015477fix_is_valid
15478 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
15479 Information eXchange):
15480
15481 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
15482 numeric
15483 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valide FIX version
15484 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
15485 - checks the MstType tag is the third tag.
15486 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
15487 checksum
15488
15489 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15490 the server can be parsed.
15491
15492 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
15493 message, false if not.
15494
15495 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
15496
15497 Example:
15498 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15499 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15500
15501fix_tag_value(<tag>)
15502 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
15503 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
15504 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
15505 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
15506 MsgType, SenderComID, TargetComID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
15507 added.
15508
15509 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15510 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
15511 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
15512 fix_is_valid converter.
15513
15514 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
15515
15516 Example:
15517 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15518 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15519 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
15520 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
15521 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
15522
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015523hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015524 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015525 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015526 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015527 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010015528
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015529hex2i
15530 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015531 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015532
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020015533htonl
15534 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
15535 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
15536 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
15537 unsigned 32-bit integer.
15538
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015539hmac(<algorithm>, <key>)
15540 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
15541 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
15542 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
15543 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
15544
15545 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15546 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15547
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015548http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015549 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15550 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015551 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
15552 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
15553 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
15554 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
15555 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
15556 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
15557 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
15558 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015559
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015560iif(<true>,<false>)
15561 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
15562 string otherwise.
15563
15564 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020015565 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015566
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015567in_table(<table>)
15568 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15569 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
15570 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015571 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015572 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
15573
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015574ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
15575 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015576 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015577 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
15578 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
15579 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
15580 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
15581 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015582
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015583json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015584 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015585 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015586 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015587 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
15588 of errors:
15589 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
15590 bytes, ...)
15591 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
15592 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
15593
15594 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
15595 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
15596 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
15597 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
15598 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
15599 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015600 - "ascii" : never fails;
15601 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
15602 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015603 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015604 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015605 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
15606 characters corresponding to the other errors.
15607
15608 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015609 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015610
15611 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015612 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015613 capture request header user-agent len 150
15614 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015615
15616 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
15617 GET / HTTP/1.0
15618 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
15619
15620 Output log:
15621 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
15622
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015623language(<value>[,<default>])
15624 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
15625 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
15626 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
15627 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
15628 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
15629 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
15630 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
15631 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
15632 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015633 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015634 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
15635 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015636
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015637 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015638
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015639 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
15640 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015641
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015642 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
15643 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
15644 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
15645 use_backend spanish if es
15646 use_backend french if fr
15647 use_backend english if en
15648 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015649
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010015650length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010015651 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
15652 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15653 type. The result is of type integer.
15654
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015655lower
15656 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
15657 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15658 type. The result is of type string.
15659
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015660ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
15661 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15662 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
15663 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15664 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15665 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15666 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
15667
15668 Example :
15669
15670 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015671 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015672 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15673
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020015674ltrim(<chars>)
15675 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
15676 representation of the input sample.
15677
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015678map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15679map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15680map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15681 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
15682 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
15683 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
15684 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
15685 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
15686 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
15687 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
15688 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015689
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015690 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
15691 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
15692 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015693
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015694 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015695 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015696
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015697 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
15698 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15699 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
15700 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020015701 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
15702 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015703 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
15704 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15705 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
15706 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15707 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
15708 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15709 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
15710 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080015711 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
15712 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15713 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015714 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15715 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
15716 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15717 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
15718 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015719
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010015720 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
15721 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
15722 the corresponding match text.
15723
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015724 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
15725 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
15726 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
15727 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
15728 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015729
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015730 Example :
15731
15732 # this is a comment and is ignored
15733 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15734 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15735 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15736 | | | `---------- value
15737 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15738 | `---------------------------- key
15739 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15740
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015741mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015742 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15743 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015744 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015745 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015746 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015747 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15748 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15749 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15750 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015751 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015752 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015753
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010015754mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname or property ID>)
15755 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
15756 <packettype>.
15757 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
15758 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
15759 from.
15760 Supported string and integers can be found here:
15761 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
15762 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
15763
15764 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
15765 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
15766 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
15767 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
15768
15769 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
15770 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
15771 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
15772 packets only):
15773 17: Session Expiry Interval
15774 33: Receive Maximum
15775 39: Maximum Packet Size
15776 34: Topic Alias Maximum
15777 25: Request Response Information
15778 23: Request Problem Information
15779 21: Authentication Method
15780 22: Authentication Data
15781 18: Will Delay Interval
15782 1: Payload Format Indicator
15783 2: Message Expiry Interval
15784 3: Content Type
15785 8: Response Topic
15786 9: Correlation Data
15787 Not supported yet:
15788 38: User Property
15789
15790 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
15791 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
15792 packets only):
15793 17: Session Expiry Interval
15794 33: Receive Maximum
15795 36: Maximum QoS
15796 37: Retain Available
15797 39: Maximum Packet Size
15798 18: Assigned Client Identifier
15799 34: Topic Alias Maximum
15800 31: Reason String
15801 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
15802 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
15803 42: Shared Subscription Available
15804 19: Server Keep Alive
15805 26: Response Information
15806 28: Server Reference
15807 21: Authentication Method
15808 22: Authentication Data
15809 Not supported yet:
15810 38: User Property
15811
15812 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15813 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
15814 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
15815 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
15816
15817 Example:
15818
15819 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
15820 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
15821 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
15822 if data_in_buffer
15823 # do the same as above
15824 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
15825 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
15826 if data_in_buffer
15827
15828mqtt_is_valid
15829 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
15830
15831 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15832 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
15833 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
15834 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
15835
15836 Example:
15837
15838 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
15839 tcp-request content reject unless req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid
15840
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015841mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015842 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015843 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15844 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015845 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015846 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015847 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015848 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15849 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15850 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15851 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015852 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015853 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015854
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015855nbsrv
15856 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15857 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15858 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15859 map lookup.
15860
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015861neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015862 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
15863 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
15864 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
15865 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015866
15867not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015868 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015869 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015870 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015871 absence of a flag).
15872
15873odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015874 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015875 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
15876
15877or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015878 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015879 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015880 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15881 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015882 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015883 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15884 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15885 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15886 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015887 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015888 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015889
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015890protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
15891 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
15892 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
15893 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
15894 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
15895 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15896 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15897 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15898 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
15899 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
15900 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15901 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
15902
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010015903regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015904 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
15905 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
15906 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
15907 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
15908 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
15909 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
15910 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
15911 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
15912 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015913 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
15914 of characters with other ones.
15915
15916 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
15917 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
15918 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
15919 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
15920 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
15921 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015922
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015923 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015924
15925 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
15926 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
15927 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015928 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015929
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015930 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
15931 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
15932
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015933 # capture groups and backreferences
15934 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020015935 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015936 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
15937
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015938capture-req(<id>)
15939 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
15940 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15941
15942 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015943 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15944 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015945
15946capture-res(<id>)
15947 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
15948 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15949
15950 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015951 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15952 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015953
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020015954rtrim(<chars>)
15955 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
15956 of the input sample.
15957
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015958sdbm([<avalanche>])
15959 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
15960 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15961 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15962 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15963 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15964 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15965 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015966 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
15967 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015968
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015969secure_memcmp(<var>)
15970 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
15971 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
15972 match.
15973
15974 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
15975 performed in constant time.
15976
15977 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15978 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15979
15980 Example :
15981
15982 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
15983 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
15984 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
15985 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
15986
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015987set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015988 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
15989 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
15990 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015991 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015992 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15993 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015994 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015995 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15996 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015997 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015998 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015999
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016000sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016001 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016002 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16003
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016004sha2([<bits>])
16005 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16006 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16007
16008 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16009 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16010
16011 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16012 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16013
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016014srv_queue
16015 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16016 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16017 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16018 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16019 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16020
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016021strcmp(<var>)
16022 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16023 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16024 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16025 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16026 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16027 shorter).
16028
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016029 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16030 strings in constant time.
16031
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016032 Example :
16033
16034 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16035 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16036 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16037
16038
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016039sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016040 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16041 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016042 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016043 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16044 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016045 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016046 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16047 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016048 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016049 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16050 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016051 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016052 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016053
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016054table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16055 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16056 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16057 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16058 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16059 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16060 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16061
16062
16063table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16064 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16065 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16066 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16067 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16068 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16069 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16070
16071table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16072 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16073 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016074 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016075 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16076 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16077
16078table_conn_cur(<table>)
16079 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16080 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16081 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16082 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16083 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16084
16085table_conn_rate(<table>)
16086 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16087 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16088 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16089 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16090 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16091
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016092table_gpt0(<table>)
16093 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16094 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16095 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16096 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16097 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16098
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016099table_gpc0(<table>)
16100 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16101 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16102 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16103 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16104 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16105
16106table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16107 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16108 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16109 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16110 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16111 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16112 sample fetch keyword.
16113
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016114table_gpc1(<table>)
16115 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16116 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16117 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16118 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16119 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16120
16121table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16122 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16123 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16124 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16125 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16126 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16127 sample fetch keyword.
16128
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016129table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16130 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16131 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016132 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016133 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16134 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16135
16136table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16137 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16138 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16139 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16140 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16141 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16142 keyword.
16143
16144table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16145 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16146 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016147 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016148 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16149 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16150
16151table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16152 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16153 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16154 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16155 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16156 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16157 keyword.
16158
16159table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16160 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16161 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016162 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016163 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16164 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16165 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16166 keyword.
16167
16168table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16169 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16170 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016171 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016172 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16173 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16174 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
16175 keyword.
16176
16177table_server_id(<table>)
16178 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16179 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16180 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
16181 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
16182 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
16183 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
16184
16185table_sess_cnt(<table>)
16186 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16187 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016188 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016189 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
16190 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16191 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
16192 keyword.
16193
16194table_sess_rate(<table>)
16195 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16196 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16197 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
16198 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
16199 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16200 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
16201 keyword.
16202
16203table_trackers(<table>)
16204 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16205 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16206 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16207 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
16208 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
16209 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
16210 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
16211 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
16212 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
16213 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
16214
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016215upper
16216 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
16217 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16218 type. The result is of type string.
16219
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020016220url_dec([<in_form>])
16221 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
16222 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
16223 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
16224 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
16225 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
16226 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020016227
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016228ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016229 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016230 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
16231 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
16232 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016233 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16234 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16235 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16236 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016237 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016238 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16239 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016240
16241 Example:
16242 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
16243 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
16244
16245 message Point {
16246 int32 latitude = 1;
16247 int32 longitude = 2;
16248 }
16249
16250 message PPoint {
16251 Point point = 59;
16252 }
16253
16254 message Rectangle {
16255 // One corner of the rectangle.
16256 PPoint lo = 48;
16257 // The other corner of the rectangle.
16258 PPoint hi = 49;
16259 }
16260
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016261 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
16262 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
16263 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016264
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016265 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16266 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016267 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016268 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
16269
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016270 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016271
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016272 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016273
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016274 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
16275 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16276 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016277
16278 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
16279 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
16280 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
16281
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016282 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
16283 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
16284 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016285
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016286
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010016287unset-var(<var name>)
16288 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
16289 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
16290 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
16291 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16292 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
16293 response),
16294 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16295 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
16296 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
16297 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
16298
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016299utime(<format>[,<offset>])
16300 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16301 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
16302 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16303 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16304 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16305 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
16306
16307 Example :
16308
16309 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016310 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016311 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16312
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016313word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16314 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
16315 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
16316 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016317 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016318 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
16319 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
16320
16321 Example :
16322 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
16323 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16324 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
16325 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
16326 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016327 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010016328
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016329wt6([<avalanche>])
16330 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
16331 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16332 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16333 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16334 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16335 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16336 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016337 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
16338 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016339
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016340xor(<value>)
16341 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016342 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016343 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016344 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016345 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016346 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16347 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016348 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016349 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16350 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016351 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016352 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016353
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010016354xxh32([<seed>])
16355 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
16356 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16357 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16358 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16359 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16360 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16361 as cryptographically secure.
16362
16363xxh64([<seed>])
16364 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
16365 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16366 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16367 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16368 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16369 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16370 as cryptographically secure.
16371
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016372
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200163737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016374--------------------------------------------
16375
16376A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
16377not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
16378"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
16379The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
16380
16381always_false : boolean
16382 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16383 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16384
16385always_true : boolean
16386 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16387 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16388
16389avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016390 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016391 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
16392 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
16393 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
16394 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
16395 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
16396 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
16397 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
16398 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
16399 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
16400 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
16401 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
16402 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
16403 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010016404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016405be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016406 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
16407 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
16408 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
16409 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016410 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
16411
16412be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
16413 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16414 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
16415 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
16416 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
16417 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016418 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
16419 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016420
16421 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
16422 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
16423 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016425be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
16426 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16427 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16428 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016429 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016430 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
16431 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016432
16433 Example :
16434 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
16435 backend dynamic
16436 mode http
16437 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
16438 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016439
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016440bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016441 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
16442 of the string.
16443
16444bool(<bool>) : bool
16445 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
16446 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
16447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016448connslots([<backend>]) : integer
16449 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016450 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016451 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
16452 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050016453
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016454 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016455 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016456 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
16457
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016458 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
16459 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016460
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016461 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016462 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016463 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016464 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016465 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016466 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016467 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016468
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016469 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
16470 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016471 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016472 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016473
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016474cpu_calls : integer
16475 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
16476 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
16477 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
16478 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
16479 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
16480 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
16481
16482cpu_ns_avg : integer
16483 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16484 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16485 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16486 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16487 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16488 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16489 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
16490 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
16491 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
16492 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
16493 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
16494
16495cpu_ns_tot : integer
16496 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16497 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16498 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16499 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16500 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16501 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16502 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
16503 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
16504 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
16505 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
16506 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
16507 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
16508 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
16509
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016510date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016511 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016512
16513 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
16514 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
16515 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016516 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
16517
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016518 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
16519 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
16520 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
16521 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
16522 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
16523
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016524 Example :
16525
16526 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
16527 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016528
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016529 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
16530 # millisecond granularity
16531 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
16532
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010016533date_us : integer
16534 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
16535 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
16536 from the same timeval structure.
16537
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020016538distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
16539 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
16540 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
16541 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
16542 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
16543 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
16544 list of supported tokens.
16545
16546distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
16547 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
16548 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
16549 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
16550 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
16551 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
16552 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
16553 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
16554 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
16555 supported tokens.
16556
16557 Example :
16558 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
16559 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
16560 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
16561 # send large files to the big farm
16562 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
16563
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020016564env(<name>) : string
16565 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
16566 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
16567 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
16568 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
16569 certain way.
16570
16571 Examples :
16572 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
16573 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
16574
16575 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
16576 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
16577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016578fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
16579 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016580 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
16581 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016582 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
16583 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016584 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016585 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
16586 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016587
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020016588fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16589 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
16590 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
16591 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
16592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016593fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16594 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16595 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16596 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
16597 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
16598 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
16599 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
16600 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
16601 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016602
16603 Example :
16604 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
16605 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
16606 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
16607 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
16608 frontend mail
16609 bind :25
16610 mode tcp
16611 maxconn 100
16612 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
16613 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
16614 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
16615 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016616
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010016617hostname : string
16618 Returns the system hostname.
16619
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016620int(<integer>) : signed integer
16621 Returns a signed integer.
16622
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016623ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
16624 Returns an ipv4.
16625
16626ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
16627 Returns an ipv6.
16628
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016629lat_ns_avg : integer
16630 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16631 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16632 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16633 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16634 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16635 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16636 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16637 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16638 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016639 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16640 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16641 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16642 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16643 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
16644 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016645
16646lat_ns_tot : integer
16647 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16648 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16649 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16650 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16651 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16652 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16653 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16654 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16655 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016656 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16657 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16658 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16659 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16660 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016661 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
16662 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
16663 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
16664 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
16665 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
16666 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
16667
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016668meth(<method>) : method
16669 Returns a method.
16670
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016671nbproc : integer
16672 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
16673 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
16674 and debugging purposes.
16675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016676nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
16677 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
16678 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
16679 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016680 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
16681 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
16682 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016683
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040016684prio_class : integer
16685 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
16686 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
16687 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
16688
16689prio_offset : integer
16690 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
16691 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
16692 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
16693 set-priority-offset".
16694
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016695proc : integer
16696 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
16697 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
16698 debugging purposes.
16699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016700queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016701 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
16702 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
16703 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016704 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
16705 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
16706 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
16707 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
16708 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
16709
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010016710rand([<range>]) : integer
16711 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
16712 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
16713 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
16714 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
16715 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
16716
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020016717uuid([<version>]) : string
16718 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
16719 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
16720 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
16721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016722srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16723 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16724 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
16725 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
16726 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
16727 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016728 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
16729 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
16730
16731srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16732 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16733 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
16734 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16735 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
16736 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
16737 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
16738 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
16739
16740 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
16741 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016742
16743srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
16744 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
16745 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
16746 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016747 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016748 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
16749 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
16750 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
16751
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020016752srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16753 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
16754 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16755 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
16756 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
16757 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
16758 fetch methods.
16759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016760srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16761 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16762 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016763 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016764 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
16765 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016766 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016767 overloading servers).
16768
16769 Example :
16770 # Redirect to a separate back
16771 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
16772 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
16773 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
16774
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020016775srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16776 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
16777 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
16778 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
16779
16780srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16781 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
16782 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16783 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
16784
16785srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16786 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
16787 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16788 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
16789
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016790stopping : boolean
16791 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
16792 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
16793 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
16794
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016795str(<string>) : string
16796 Returns a string.
16797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016798table_avl([<table>]) : integer
16799 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
16800 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
16801
16802table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16803 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
16804 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
16805 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
16806
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010016807thread : integer
16808 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
16809 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
16810 and debugging purposes.
16811
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016812var(<var-name>) : undefined
16813 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016814 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
16815 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016816 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016817 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16818 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016819 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016820 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16821 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016822 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016823 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016824
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200168257.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016826----------------------------------
16827
16828The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
16829closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
16830methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
16831sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
16832TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016833the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
16834counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020016835"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
16836used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
16837can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
16838Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
16839table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
16840tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
16841currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016842
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010016843bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010016844 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16845 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16846 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
16847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016848be_id : integer
16849 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016850 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16851 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016852
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016853be_name : string
16854 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016855 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16856 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016858dst : ip
16859 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
16860 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
16861 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
16862 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016863 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
16864 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
16865 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
16866 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
16867 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
16868 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016869
16870dst_conn : integer
16871 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16872 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
16873 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
16874 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
16875 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
16876 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
16877 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
16878 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016879
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016880dst_is_local : boolean
16881 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
16882 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
16883 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
16884 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016885 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016886 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
16887 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
16888 it only once per connection.
16889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016890dst_port : integer
16891 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
16892 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
16893 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
16894 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
16895 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
16896 an HTTP header.
16897
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020016898fc_http_major : integer
16899 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16900 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16901 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
16902
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020016903fc_pp_authority : string
16904 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16905 if any.
16906
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010016907fc_pp_unique_id : string
16908 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16909 if any.
16910
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010016911fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
16912 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
16913 header.
16914
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020016915fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
16916 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
16917 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
16918 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
16919 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16920 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16921 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16922
16923fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
16924 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
16925 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
16926 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
16927 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16928 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16929 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16930
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016931fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016932 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16933 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16934 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16935 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16936
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016937fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016938 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16939 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16940 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16941 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16942
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016943fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016944 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
16945 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16946 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16947 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16948
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016949fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016950 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
16951 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16952 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16953 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16954
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016955fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016956 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
16957 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16958 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16959 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16960
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016961fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016962 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
16963 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16964 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16965 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16966
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020016967fe_defbe : string
16968 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
16969 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
16970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016971fe_id : integer
16972 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010016973 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016974 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16975
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016976fe_name : string
16977 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
16978 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
16979 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16980
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016981sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016982sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16983sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16984sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016985 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
16986 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16987 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
16988
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016989sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016990sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16991sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16992sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016993 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
16994 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16995 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
16996
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016997sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016998sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16999sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17000sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017001 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17002 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017003 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17004 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17005 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017006
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017007 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017008 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17009 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017010 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17011 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17012 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017013 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17014 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17015
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017016sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17017sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17018sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17019sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17020 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17021 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17022 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17023 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17024 when a first ACL was verified.
17025
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017026sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017027sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17028sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17029sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017030 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017031 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17032
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017033sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017034sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17035sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17036sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017037 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17038 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17039 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17040
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017041sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017042sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17043sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17044sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017045 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17046 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17047 See also src_conn_rate.
17048
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017049sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017050sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17051sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17052sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017053 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017054 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017055
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017056sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17057sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17058sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17059sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17060 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17061 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17062
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017063sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17064sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17065sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17066sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17067 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17068 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17069
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017070sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017071sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17072sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17073sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017074 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17075 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17076 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017077 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17078 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17079 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017080
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017081sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17082sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17083sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17084sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17085 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17086 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17087 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17088 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17089 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17090 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17091
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017092sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017093sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17094sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17095sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017096 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017097 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
17098 See also src_http_err_cnt.
17099
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017100sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017101sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17102sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17103sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017104 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
17105 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17106 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
17107 src_http_err_rate.
17108
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017109sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017110sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17111sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17112sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017113 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017114 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17115 src_http_req_cnt.
17116
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017117sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017118sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17119sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17120sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017121 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
17122 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
17123 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17124 src_http_req_rate.
17125
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017126sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017127sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17128sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17129sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017130 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017131 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17132 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17133 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17134 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017135
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017136 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017137 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17138 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017139 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17140
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017141sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17142sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17143sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17144sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17145 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
17146 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17147 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17148 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17149 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
17150
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017151sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017152sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17153sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17154sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017155 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
17156 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17157 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017158
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017159sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017160sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17161sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17162sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017163 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
17164 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17165 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017166
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017167sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017168sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17169sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17170sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017171 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017172 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
17173 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
17174 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017175 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017176 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
17177
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017178sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017179sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17180sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17181sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017182 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
17183 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17184 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
17185 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
17186 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017187 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017188
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017189sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017190sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17191sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17192sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020017193 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
17194 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
17195 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
17196
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017197sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017198sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17199sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17200sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017201 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17202 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017203 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017204 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
17205 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017206 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
17207 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
17208 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017210so_id : integer
17211 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
17212 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
17213 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017214
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010017215so_name : string
17216 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
17217 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
17218 strings instead of integers.
17219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017220src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017221 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017222 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
17223 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
17224 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017225 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
17226 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
17227 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017228 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
17229 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
17230 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
17231 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
17232 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
17233 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
17234 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017235
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017236 Example:
17237 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
17238 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
17239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017240src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17241 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
17242 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
17243 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017244 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017246src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17247 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
17248 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017249 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017250 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017252src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17253 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17254 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17255 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17256 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17257 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17258 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017259
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017260 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017261 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17262 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
17263 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
17264 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017265 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017266 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17267 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17268
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017269src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17270 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17271 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17272 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17273 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17274 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17275 was verified.
17276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017277src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017278 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017279 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017280 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017281 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017283src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017284 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017285 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17286 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017287 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017289src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17290 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
17291 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17292 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017293 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017295src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017296 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017297 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017298 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017299 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017300
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017301src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17302 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17303 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17304 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17305 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
17306
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017307src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17308 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17309 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17310 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17311 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
17312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017313src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017314 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017315 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017316 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17317 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017318 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17319 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17320 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017321
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017322src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17323 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17324 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17325 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17326 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17327 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17328 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17329 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017331src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017332 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017333 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017334 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017335 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017336 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017338src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17339 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
17340 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17341 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17342 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017343 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017345src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017346 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017347 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17348 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017349 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017351src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17352 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
17353 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17354 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017355 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017356 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017358src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17359 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17360 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17361 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017362 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017363 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17364 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017365
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017366 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017367 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017368 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017369 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017370
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017371src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17372 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17373 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17374 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
17375 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17376 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17377 connection when a first ACL was verified.
17378
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017379src_is_local : boolean
17380 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
17381 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
17382 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
17383 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017384 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017385 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
17386 once per connection.
17387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017388src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017389 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
17390 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
17391 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
17392 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
17393 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017395src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017396 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
17397 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17398 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
17399 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
17400 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017402src_port : integer
17403 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17404 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
17405 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
17406 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017408src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017409 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017410 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17411 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
17412 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017413 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017415src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17416 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
17417 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17418 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17419 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017420 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017422src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17423 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
17424 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
17425 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
17426 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
17427 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
17428 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
17429 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
17430 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017431
17432 Example :
17433 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
17434 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
17435 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
17436 listen ssh
17437 bind :22
17438 mode tcp
17439 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017440 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017441 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017442 server local 127.0.0.1:22
17443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017444srv_id : integer
17445 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
17446 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017447 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020017448
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017449srv_name : string
17450 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
17451 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017452 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017453
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200174547.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017455----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020017456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017457The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
17458closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
17459when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
17460usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017461future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017462
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001746351d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
17464 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
17465 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
17466 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
17467 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
17468 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
17469
17470 Example :
17471 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
17472 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
17473 # the request.
17474 frontend http-in
17475 bind *:8081
17476 default_backend servers
17477 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
17478 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
17479
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017480ssl_bc : boolean
17481 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17482 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017483 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17484 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017485
17486ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
17487 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017488 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17489 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017490
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017491ssl_bc_alpn : string
17492 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
17493 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017494 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017495 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17496 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17497 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
17498 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
17499 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017500 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
17501 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017502
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017503ssl_bc_cipher : string
17504 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017505 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17506 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017507
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017508ssl_bc_client_random : binary
17509 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17510 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17511 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017512 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017513
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017514ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
17515 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17516 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017517 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17518 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017519
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017520ssl_bc_npn : string
17521 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
17522 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017523 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017524 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
17525 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
17526 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
17527 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017528 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
17529 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017530
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017531ssl_bc_protocol : string
17532 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017533 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17534 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017535
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017536ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017537 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017538 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017539 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
17540 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017541
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017542ssl_bc_server_random : binary
17543 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17544 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17545 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017546 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017547
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017548ssl_bc_session_id : binary
17549 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
17550 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017551 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17552 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017553
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017554ssl_bc_session_key : binary
17555 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
17556 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17557 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017558 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017559
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017560ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
17561 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017562 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17563 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017565ssl_c_ca_err : integer
17566 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17567 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
17568 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
17569 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
17570 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017572ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
17573 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17574 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
17575 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
17576 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017577
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017578ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017579 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
17580 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17581 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17582 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17583 does not support resumed sessions.
17584
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017585ssl_c_der : binary
17586 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
17587 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17588 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017590ssl_c_err : integer
17591 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17592 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
17593 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
17594 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
17595 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017596
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017597ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017598 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17599 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17600 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17601 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17602 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17603 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17604 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17605 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017606 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17607 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17608 LDAP v3.
17609 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17610 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017612ssl_c_key_alg : string
17613 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17614 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17615 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017617ssl_c_notafter : string
17618 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
17619 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17620 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017622ssl_c_notbefore : string
17623 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
17624 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17625 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017626
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017627ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017628 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17629 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17630 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17631 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17632 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17633 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17634 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17635 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017636 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17637 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17638 LDAP v3.
17639 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17640 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017642ssl_c_serial : binary
17643 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
17644 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17645 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017647ssl_c_sha1 : binary
17648 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
17649 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
17650 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017651 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
17652 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
17653
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017654 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017655 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017657ssl_c_sig_alg : string
17658 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17659 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17660 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017662ssl_c_used : boolean
17663 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
17664 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017666ssl_c_verify : integer
17667 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
17668 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
17669 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
17670 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017672ssl_c_version : integer
17673 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
17674 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017675
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017676ssl_f_der : binary
17677 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
17678 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17679 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17680
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017681ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017682 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17683 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17684 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17685 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017686 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017687 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17688 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17689 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017690 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17691 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17692 LDAP v3.
17693 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17694 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017696ssl_f_key_alg : string
17697 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17698 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
17699 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017701ssl_f_notafter : string
17702 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17703 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17704 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017706ssl_f_notbefore : string
17707 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17708 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17709 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017710
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017711ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017712 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17713 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17714 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17715 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17716 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17717 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17718 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17719 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017720 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17721 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17722 LDAP v3.
17723 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17724 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017726ssl_f_serial : binary
17727 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17728 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17729 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017730
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020017731ssl_f_sha1 : binary
17732 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
17733 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17734 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017736ssl_f_sig_alg : string
17737 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17738 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17739 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017741ssl_f_version : integer
17742 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17743 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17744
17745ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017746 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17747 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
17748 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
17749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017750 Example :
17751 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
17752 listen http-https
17753 bind :80
17754 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
17755 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
17756
17757ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
17758 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
17759 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17760
17761ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017762 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017763 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
17764 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
17765 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17766 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17767 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
17768 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
17769 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
17770 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
17771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017772ssl_fc_cipher : string
17773 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
17774 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020017775
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017776ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
17777 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
17778 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017779 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017780
17781ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
17782 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
17783 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017784 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017785
17786ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
17787 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
17788 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
17789 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017790 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020017791 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017792
17793ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
17794 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
17795 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017796 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017797
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017798ssl_fc_client_random : binary
17799 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17800 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17801 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17802
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017803ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
17804 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17805 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17806 transport layer.
17807 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17808 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17809 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17810 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17811
17812ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17813 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17814 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17815 transport layer.
17816 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17817 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17818 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17819 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17820
17821ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
17822 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17823 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17824 transport layer.
17825 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17826 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17827 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17828 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17829
17830ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
17831 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17832 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17833 transport layer.
17834 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17835 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17836 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17837 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17838
17839ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
17840 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17841 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17842 transport layer.
17843 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17844 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17845 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17846 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017848ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017849 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
17850 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010017851 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
17852 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
17853 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
17854 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017855
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020017856ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
17857 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
17858 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
17859 wait until the handshake happened.
17860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017861ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
17862 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017863 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
17864 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017865 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017866 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017867
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020017868ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017869 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010017870 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
17871 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017873ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017874 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017875 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
17876 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
17877 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
17878 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
17879 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
17880 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
17881 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020017882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017883ssl_fc_protocol : string
17884 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
17885 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017886
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017887ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017888 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017889 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
17890 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017891
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017892ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17893 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17894 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17895 transport layer.
17896 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17897 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17898 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17899 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17900
17901ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
17902 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17903 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17904 transport layer.
17905 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17906 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17907 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17908 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17909
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017910ssl_fc_server_random : binary
17911 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17912 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17913 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017915ssl_fc_session_id : binary
17916 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
17917 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
17918 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
17919 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017920
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017921ssl_fc_session_key : binary
17922 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
17923 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17924 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
17925 BoringSSL.
17926
17927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017928ssl_fc_sni : string
17929 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
17930 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
17931 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
17932 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
17933 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
17934
17935 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
17936 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
17937 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017938 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020017939 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017941 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017942 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
17943 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020017944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017945ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
17946 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
17947 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017948
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017949ssl_s_der : binary
17950 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
17951 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17952 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17953
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017954ssl_s_chain_der : binary
17955 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
17956 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17957 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17958 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17959 does not support resumed sessions.
17960
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017961ssl_s_key_alg : string
17962 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17963 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
17964 SSL/TLS transport layer.
17965
17966ssl_s_notafter : string
17967 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
17968 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17969 transport layer.
17970
17971ssl_s_notbefore : string
17972 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
17973 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17974 transport layer.
17975
17976ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17977 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17978 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17979 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17980 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17981 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17982 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017983 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17984 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017985 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17986 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17987 LDAP v3.
17988 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17989 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17990
17991ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17992 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17993 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17994 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17995 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17996 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17997 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017998 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17999 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018000 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18001 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18002 LDAP v3.
18003 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18004 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18005
18006ssl_s_serial : binary
18007 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
18008 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18009 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18010
18011ssl_s_sha1 : binary
18012 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
18013 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18014 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18015
18016ssl_s_sig_alg : string
18017 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18018 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18019 layer.
18020
18021ssl_s_version : integer
18022 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
18023 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018024
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200180257.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018026------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018028Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
18029sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
18030only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
18031For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
18032be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
18033can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
18034sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
18035for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
18036content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018038payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018039 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018040 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
18041 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018043payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
18044 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018045 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018046 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018048req.len : integer
18049req_len : integer (deprecated)
18050 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18051 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18052 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18053 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18054 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18055 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18056 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
18057 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018059req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18060 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018061 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
18062 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
18063 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
18064 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018066 ACL alternatives :
18067 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018069req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18070 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18071 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18072 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
18073 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018075 ACL alternatives :
18076 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018078 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018080req.proto_http : boolean
18081req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
18082 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
18083 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
18084 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
18085 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
18086 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
18087 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
18088 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018090 Example:
18091 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
18092 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18093 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018094 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018096req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
18097rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18098 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
18099 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
18100 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
18101 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
18102 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
18103 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
18104 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018106 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
18107 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
18108 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
18109 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
18110 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
18111 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018113 ACL derivatives :
18114 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018116 Example :
18117 listen tse-farm
18118 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
18119 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
18120 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18121 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
18122 # apply RDP cookie persistence
18123 persist rdp-cookie
18124 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
18125 # This is only useful makes sense if
18126 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
18127 stick-table type string size 204800
18128 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
18129 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
18130 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018132 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
18133 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018135req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
18136rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
18137 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
18138 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
18139 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
18140 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018142 ACL derivatives :
18143 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018144
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018145req.ssl_alpn : string
18146 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
18147 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
18148 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
18149 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
18150 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
18151 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018152 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018153
18154 Examples :
18155 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18156 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18157 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018158 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018159 default_backend bk_default
18160
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018161req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
18162 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
18163 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020018164 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
18165 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
18166 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
18167 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
18168 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018170req.ssl_hello_type : integer
18171req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18172 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18173 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
18174 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18175 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18176 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
18177 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18178 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018180req.ssl_sni : string
18181req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
18182 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
18183 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
18184 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
18185 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18186 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020018187 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
18188 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
18189 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
18190 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
18191 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
18192 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
18193 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
18194 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
18195 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018197 ACL derivatives :
18198 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018200 Examples :
18201 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18202 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18203 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
18204 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
18205 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018206
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053018207req.ssl_st_ext : integer
18208 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
18209 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
18210 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
18211 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
18212 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
18213 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
18214 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
18215 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
18216 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
18217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018218req.ssl_ver : integer
18219req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
18220 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
18221 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
18222 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
18223 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
18224 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18225 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
18226 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018227 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018228 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018230 ACL derivatives :
18231 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018232
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018233res.len : integer
18234 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18235 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18236 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18237 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18238 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18239 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18240 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018241 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018243res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18244 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018245 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018246 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018247 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018248 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018250res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18251 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18252 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18253 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018254 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
18255 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018257 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018258
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020018259res.ssl_hello_type : integer
18260rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18261 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18262 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
18263 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18264 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18265 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
18266 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18267 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
18268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018269wait_end : boolean
18270 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
18271 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018272 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018273 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
18274 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018275 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018276 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
18277 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018279 Examples :
18280 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
18281 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
18282 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018284 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
18285 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18286 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
18287 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
18288 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
18289 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
18290 tcp-request content reject
18291
18292
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200182937.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018294--------------------------------------
18295
18296It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
18297This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
18298data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
18299its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
18300HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
18301content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
18302to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
18303more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
18304response are indexed.
18305
18306base : string
18307 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
18308 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
18309 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
18310 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
18311 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
18312 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
18313 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
18314 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
18315
18316 ACL derivatives :
18317 base : exact string match
18318 base_beg : prefix match
18319 base_dir : subdir match
18320 base_dom : domain match
18321 base_end : suffix match
18322 base_len : length match
18323 base_reg : regex match
18324 base_sub : substring match
18325
18326base32 : integer
18327 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
18328 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
18329 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018330 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
18331 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
18332 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018333
18334base32+src : binary
18335 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
18336 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
18337 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
18338 per-URL counters.
18339
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018340capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
18341 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
18342 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18343 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
18344
18345capture.req.method : string
18346 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
18347 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
18348 because it's allocated.
18349
18350capture.req.uri : string
18351 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
18352 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
18353 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
18354 allocated.
18355
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018356capture.req.ver : string
18357 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18358 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
18359 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
18360
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018361capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
18362 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
18363 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18364 The first entry is an index of 0.
18365 See also: "capture response header"
18366
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018367capture.res.ver : string
18368 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18369 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
18370 persistent flag.
18371
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018372req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018373 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
18374 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
18375 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018376
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020018377req.body_param([<name>) : string
18378 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
18379 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
18380 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
18381 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
18382 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
18383 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
18384 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
18385 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
18386 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
18387 given.
18388
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018389req.body_len : integer
18390 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
18391 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018392 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
18393 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018394
18395req.body_size : integer
18396 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018397 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18398 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018400req.cook([<name>]) : string
18401cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18402 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18403 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
18404 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
18405 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
18406 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
18407 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
18408 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
18409 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
18410
18411 ACL derivatives :
18412 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
18413 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
18414 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
18415 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
18416 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
18417 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
18418 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
18419 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018421req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18422cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18423 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18424 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018426req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18427cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18428 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18429 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
18430 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
18431 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018433cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18434 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18435 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
18436 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
18437 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018438 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018439 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
18440 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
18441 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
18442 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018444hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18445 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
18446 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
18447 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
18448 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018449 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018451req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
18452 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
18453 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
18454 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18455 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18456 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18457 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
18458 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
18459 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018461req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18462 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18463 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18464 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
18465 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018467req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18468 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
18469 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
18470 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18471 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18472 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18473 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
18474 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
18475 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000018476 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018477 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018478 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018480 ACL derivatives :
18481 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18482 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18483 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18484 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18485 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18486 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18487 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18488 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18489
18490req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18491hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
18492 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18493 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
18494 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
18495 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
18496 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
18497 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
18498 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
18499 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
18500 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
18501
18502req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18503hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18504 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
18505 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
18506 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
18507 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18508 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018509 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018510 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
18511 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
18512
18513req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18514hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18515 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
18516 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
18517 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
18518 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18519 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18520 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18521 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
18522
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010018523req.hdrs : string
18524 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
18525 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18526 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
18527 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
18528
18529req.hdrs_bin : binary
18530 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18531 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
18532 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
18533 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
18534 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
18535 names and values (length of 0 for both).
18536
18537 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018538
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010018539 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18540 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018542http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
18543 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
18544 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
18545 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18546 basic auth is supported.
18547
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018548http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
18549 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
18550 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
18551 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
18552 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018553 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18554 basic auth is supported.
18555
18556 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018557 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
18558 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
18559 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
18560 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018561
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018562http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018563 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
18564 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18565 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018566
18567http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018568 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
18569 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18570 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018571
18572http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018573 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
18574 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
18575 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018577http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018578 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
18579 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018580 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
18581 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018583method : integer + string
18584 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
18585 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
18586 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
18587 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
18588 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
18589 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
18590 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018592 ACL derivatives :
18593 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018595 Example :
18596 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
18597 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
18598 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018600path : string
18601 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
18602 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
18603 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
18604 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
18605 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018606 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018607 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018609 ACL derivatives :
18610 path : exact string match
18611 path_beg : prefix match
18612 path_dir : subdir match
18613 path_dom : domain match
18614 path_end : suffix match
18615 path_len : length match
18616 path_reg : regex match
18617 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018618
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020018619pathq : string
18620 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
18621 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
18622 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
18623 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
18624 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
18625 result in both cases.
18626
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018627query : string
18628 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
18629 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
18630 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
18631 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018632 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018633 which stops before the question mark.
18634
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018635req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18636 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18637 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18638 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
18639 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
18640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018641req.ver : string
18642req_ver : string (deprecated)
18643 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
18644 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
18645 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018647 ACL derivatives :
18648 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018649
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018650res.body : binary
18651 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
18652 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18653 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18654 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18655
18656res.body_len : integer
18657 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
18658 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18659 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18660 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18661
18662res.body_size : integer
18663 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
18664 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18665 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
18666 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
18667 useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It may be used in tcp-check
18668 based expect rules.
18669
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010018670res.cache_hit : boolean
18671 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
18672 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
18673
18674res.cache_name : string
18675 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
18676 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
18677 empty string.
18678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018679res.comp : boolean
18680 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
18681 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
18682 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018684res.comp_algo : string
18685 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
18686 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
18687 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018689res.cook([<name>]) : string
18690scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18691 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18692 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018693 specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may be used in tcp-check
18694 based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018696 ACL derivatives :
18697 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018699res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18700scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18701 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18702 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018703 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses. It may
18704 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018706res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18707scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18708 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18709 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018710 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may
18711 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018713res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18714 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18715 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18716 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18717 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18718 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
18719 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
18720 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
18721 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018722 Expires. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018724res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18725 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18726 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18727 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
18728 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018729 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in
18730 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018732res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18733shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
18734 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18735 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18736 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18737 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18738 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
18739 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
18740 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018741 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in tcp-check based
18742 expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018744 ACL derivatives :
18745 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18746 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18747 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18748 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18749 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18750 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18751 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18752 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18753
18754res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18755shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18756 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18757 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18758 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
18759 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018760 instead. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018762res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18763shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18764 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
18765 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
18766 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
18767 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
18768 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018769 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table. It
18770 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018771
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018772res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18773 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18774 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18775 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018776 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered. It may be used
18777 in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018779res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18780shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18781 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
18782 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18783 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
18784 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
18785 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018786 useful to learn some data into a stick table. It may be used in tcp-check
18787 based expect rules.
18788
18789res.hdrs : string
18790 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
18791 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18792 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
18793 headers analyzers and for advanced logging. It may also be used in tcp-check
18794 based expect rules.
18795
18796res.hdrs_bin : binary
18797 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18798 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
18799 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
18800 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
18801 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
18802 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
18803 (length of 0 for both).
18804
18805 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
18806
18807 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18808 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018810res.ver : string
18811resp_ver : string (deprecated)
18812 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018813 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. It may be used in
18814 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018816 ACL derivatives :
18817 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018819set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18820 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18821 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018822 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018823 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018825 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
18826 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018828status : integer
18829 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
18830 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018831 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx. It may be used in
18832 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018833
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020018834unique-id : string
18835 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
18836 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
18837 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
18838 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
18839 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
18840 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
18841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018842url : string
18843 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
18844 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
18845 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
18846 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
18847 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
18848 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
18849 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018851 ACL derivatives :
18852 url : exact string match
18853 url_beg : prefix match
18854 url_dir : subdir match
18855 url_dom : domain match
18856 url_end : suffix match
18857 url_len : length match
18858 url_reg : regex match
18859 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018861url_ip : ip
18862 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
18863 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
18864 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
18865 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
18866 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
18867 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18868 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018870url_port : integer
18871 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
18872 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
18873 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18874 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018875
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018876urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
18877url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018878 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
18879 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018880 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
18881 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
18882 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
18883 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018884 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
18885 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018886 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
18887 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018889 ACL derivatives :
18890 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
18891 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
18892 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
18893 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
18894 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
18895 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
18896 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
18897 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018898
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018900 Example :
18901 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
18902 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
18903 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
18904 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018905
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018906urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018907 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
18908 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
18909 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020018910
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020018911url32 : integer
18912 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
18913 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
18914 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
18915 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
18916 is an unsigned integer.
18917
18918url32+src : binary
18919 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
18920 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
18921 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
18922
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020018923
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200189247.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018925---------------------------------------
18926
18927This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
18928used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
18929purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
18930There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
18931or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
18932any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
18933for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
18934
18935internal.htx.data : integer
18936 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
18937 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18938
18939internal.htx.free : integer
18940 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
18941 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18942
18943internal.htx.free_data : integer
18944 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
18945 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18946
18947internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
18948 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
18949 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
18950 chosen depending on the sample direction.
18951
18952internal.htx.nbblks : integer
18953 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
18954 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18955
18956internal.htx.size : integer
18957 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
18958 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18959
18960internal.htx.used : integer
18961 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
18962 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18963 direction.
18964
18965internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
18966 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18967 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
18968 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
18969 of the special value :
18970 * head : The oldest inserted block
18971 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018972 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018973
18974internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
18975 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18976 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
18977 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
18978 integer or one of the special value :
18979 * head : The oldest inserted block
18980 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018981 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018982
18983internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
18984 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18985 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
18986 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18987 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18988
18989 * head : The oldest inserted block
18990 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018991 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018992
18993internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
18994 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18995 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18996 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18997 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18998
18999 * head : The oldest inserted block
19000 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019001 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019002
19003internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
19004 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19005 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19006 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19007 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19008
19009 * head : The oldest inserted block
19010 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019011 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019012
19013internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
19014 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
19015 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
19016 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19017 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19018
19019 * head : The oldest inserted block
19020 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019021 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019022
19023internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
19024 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
19025 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
19026 it returns false.
19027
19028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200190297.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019030---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019031
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019032Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
19033every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020019034order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019035
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019036ACL name Equivalent to Usage
19037---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019038FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020019039HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019040HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
19041HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019042HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
19043HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
19044HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
19045HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
19046LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019047METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020019048METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019049METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
19050METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
19051METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
19052METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020019053METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019054METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020019055RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019056REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019057TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019058WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
19059---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019060
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010019061
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190628. Logging
19063----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019064
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019065One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
19066provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
19067very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
19068provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
19069state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019070to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019071headers.
19072
19073In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
19074about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
19075send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
19076
19077 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
19078 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
19079 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
19080 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
19081 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019082 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060019083 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019084
19085The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
19086allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
19087as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
19088while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
19089real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
19090delay.
19091
19092
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190938.1. Log levels
19094---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019095
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019096TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019097source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019098HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
19099in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
19100track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
19101syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
19102about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019103
19104
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191058.2. Log formats
19106----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019107
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019108HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019109and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
19110slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
19111options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019112
19113 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
19114 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
19115 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
19116 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
19117 extents.
19118
19119 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
19120 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
19121 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
19122 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
19123 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
19124
19125 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
19126 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
19127 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
19128 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
19129 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
19130
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020019131 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
19132 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
19133 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
19134 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
19135
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019136 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
19137
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019138Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
19139specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
19140field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
19141servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
19142always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
19143identifier.
19144
19145Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
19146 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
19147 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
19148 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
19149 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
19150
19151
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191528.2.1. Default log format
19153-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019154
19155This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
19156as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
19157format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
19158
19159 Example :
19160 listen www
19161 mode http
19162 log global
19163 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19164
19165 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
19166 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
19167 (www/HTTP)
19168
19169 Field Format Extract from the example above
19170 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
19171 2 'Connect from' Connect from
19172 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
19173 4 'to' to
19174 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
19175 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
19176
19177Detailed fields description :
19178 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
19179 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
19180 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
19181 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
19182 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19183 and processed the connection.
19184 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
19185
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019186In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
19187"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
19188connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
19189
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019190It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
19191will eventually disappear.
19192
19193
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191948.2.2. TCP log format
19195---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019196
19197The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
19198is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
19199information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
19200counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
19201emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
19202environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
19203the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
19204sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019205specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
19206not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
19207fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
19208marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019209
19210 Example :
19211 frontend fnt
19212 mode tcp
19213 option tcplog
19214 log global
19215 default_backend bck
19216
19217 backend bck
19218 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19219
19220 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
19221 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
19222 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
19223
19224 Field Format Extract from the example above
19225 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
19226 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
19227 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
19228 4 frontend_name fnt
19229 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
19230 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
19231 7 bytes_read* 212
19232 8 termination_state --
19233 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
19234 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19235
19236Detailed fields description :
19237 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019238 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19239 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19240 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019241 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019242 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019243 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019244
19245 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019246 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19247 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19248 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019249
19250 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
19251 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
19252 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019253 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
19254 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
19255 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
19256 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019257
19258 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19259 and processed the connection.
19260
19261 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19262 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19263 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
19264 applications.
19265
19266 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19267 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19268 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19269 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
19270 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
19271
19272 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19273 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
19274 See "Timers" below for more details.
19275
19276 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19277 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
19278 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
19279 "Timers" below for more details.
19280
19281 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019282 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019283 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
19284 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
19285 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
19286 details.
19287
19288 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
19289 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
19290 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
19291 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
19292 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
19293
19294 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19295 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19296 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
19297 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
19298 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
19299 for more details.
19300
19301 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019302 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019303 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
19304 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
19305 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019306 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019307
19308 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19309 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19310 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19311 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19312 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19313 caused by a denial of service attack.
19314
19315 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19316 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19317 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19318 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19319 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19320 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19321 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19322 denial of service attack.
19323
19324 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19325 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19326 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19327 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19328 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19329 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19330 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19331 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
19332 be processed than on other servers.
19333
19334 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19335 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19336 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19337 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19338 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19339 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19340 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19341 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19342 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19343 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19344 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19345 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19346 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19347
19348 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19349 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19350 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19351 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19352 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19353 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019354 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019355 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19356
19357 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19358 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19359 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19360 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19361 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19362 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019363 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019364 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19365 occurs.
19366
19367
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193688.2.3. HTTP log format
19369----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019370
19371The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
19372is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
19373the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
19374are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
19375emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
19376generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
19377"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
19378which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019379frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
19380is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019381
19382Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
19383slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
19384with a star ('*') after the field name below.
19385
19386 Example :
19387 frontend http-in
19388 mode http
19389 option httplog
19390 log global
19391 default_backend bck
19392
19393 backend static
19394 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19395
19396 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
19397 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
19398 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019399 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019400
19401 Field Format Extract from the example above
19402 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
19403 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019404 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019405 4 frontend_name http-in
19406 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019407 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019408 7 status_code 200
19409 8 bytes_read* 2750
19410 9 captured_request_cookie -
19411 10 captured_response_cookie -
19412 11 termination_state ----
19413 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
19414 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19415 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
19416 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
19417 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019418
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019419Detailed fields description :
19420 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019421 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19422 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19423 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019424 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019425 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019426 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019427
19428 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019429 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19430 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19431 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019432
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019433 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
19434 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019435
19436 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19437 and processed the connection.
19438
19439 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19440 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19441 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
19442
19443 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19444 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19445 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19446 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
19447 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
19448 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
19449
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019450 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
19451 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
19452 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019453 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019454 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
19455 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019456 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
19457 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019458
19459 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19460 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019461 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019462
19463 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19464 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019465 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
19466 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019467
19468 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
19469 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
19470 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
19471 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
19472 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019473 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
19474 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019475
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019476 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
19477 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
19478 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
19479 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
19480 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
19481 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
19482 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019483 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019484
19485 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
19486 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
19487 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
19488
19489 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
19490 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019491 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019492 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
19493 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
19494 overflowing.
19495
19496 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
19497 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
19498 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
19499 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
19500 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
19501 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
19502 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
19503 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19504
19505 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
19506 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
19507 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
19508 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
19509 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
19510 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
19511 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
19512 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19513
19514 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19515 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19516 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
19517 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
19518 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
19519 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
19520 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
19521
19522 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019523 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019524 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
19525 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
19526 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019527 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019528 system.
19529
19530 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19531 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19532 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19533 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19534 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19535 caused by a denial of service attack.
19536
19537 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19538 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19539 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19540 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19541 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19542 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19543 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19544 denial of service attack.
19545
19546 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19547 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19548 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19549 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19550 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19551 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19552 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19553 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
19554 processed than on other servers.
19555
19556 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19557 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19558 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19559 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19560 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19561 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19562 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19563 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19564 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19565 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19566 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19567 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19568 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19569
19570 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19571 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19572 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19573 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19574 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19575 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019576 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019577 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19578
19579 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19580 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19581 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19582 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19583 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19584 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019585 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019586 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19587 occurs.
19588
19589 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
19590 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
19591 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
19592 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
19593 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
19594 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
19595 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
19596 cookies" below for more details.
19597
19598 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
19599 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
19600 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
19601 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
19602 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
19603 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
19604 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
19605 and cookies" below for more details.
19606
19607 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
19608 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
19609 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
19610 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
19611 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
19612 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
19613 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
19614 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
19615
19616
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200196178.2.4. Custom log format
19618------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019619
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019620The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019621mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019622
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019623HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019624Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
19625separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
19626prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
19627
19628Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
19629variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019630("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019631
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019632If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020019633as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019634less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
19635the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
19636
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020019637Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
19638"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
19639delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
19640preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019641
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019642Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
19643'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
19644https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
19645such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
19646
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019647Flags are :
19648 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019649 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019650 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
19651 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019652
19653 Example:
19654
19655 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
19656 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
19657
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019658 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
19659
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019660At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
19661
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019662 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
19663 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019664
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019665the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019666
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019667 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
19668 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
19669 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019670
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019671and the default TCP format is defined this way :
19672
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019673 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
19674 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019675
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019676Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
19677
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019678 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019679 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019680 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
19681 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
19682 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019683 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
19684 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
19685 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019686 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019687 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000019688 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000019689 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000019690 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019691 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
19692 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010019693 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020019694 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019695 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019696 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019697 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020019698 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080019699 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019700 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
19701 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
19702 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
19703 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
19704 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019705 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019706 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019707 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019708 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019709 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019710 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
19711 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019712 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19713 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
19714 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019715 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019716 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
19717 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019718 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019719 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19720 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
19721 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020019722 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020019723 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019724 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
19725 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
19726 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
19727 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020019728 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019729 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019730 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019731 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010019732 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019733 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019734 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
19735 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
19736 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019737 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019738 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
19739 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019740 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019741 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
19742 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020019743 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019744 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019745 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019746 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019747
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019748 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019749
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019750
197518.2.5. Error log format
19752-----------------------
19753
19754When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
19755protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
19756By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
19757"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019758will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019759logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
19760
19761The format looks like this :
19762
19763 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
19764 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
19765 Connection error during SSL handshake
19766
19767 Field Format Extract from the example above
19768 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
19769 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
19770 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
19771 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
19772 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
19773
19774These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
19775failures.
19776
19777
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197788.3. Advanced logging options
19779-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019780
19781Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
19782just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
19783options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
19784for more information about their usage.
19785
19786
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197878.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
19788------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019789
19790It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
19791haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
19792commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
19793monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
19794ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
19795
19796 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
19797 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
19798 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
19799 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
19800
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020019801 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
19802 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019803
19804 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
19805 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
19806 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
19807
19808
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198098.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
19810----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019811
19812The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
19813what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
19814or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019815"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019816just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
19817log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
19818after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
19819is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
19820with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
19821with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
19822
19823
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198248.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
19825------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019826
19827Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
19828for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
19829"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
19830retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
19831raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
19832a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
19833file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
19834you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
19835"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
19836
19837
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198388.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
19839--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019840
19841Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
19842multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
19843them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
19844"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
19845logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
19846error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
19847and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
19848too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
19849useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
19850alternative.
19851
19852
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198538.4. Timing events
19854------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019855
19856Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
19857reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
19858the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
19859frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019860mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
19861addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
19862
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019863Timings events in HTTP mode:
19864
19865 first request 2nd request
19866 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
19867 t tr t tr ...
19868 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
19869 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
19870 :<---- Tq ---->: :
19871 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019872 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019873 :<--------- Ta --------->:
19874
19875Timings events in TCP mode:
19876
19877 TCP session
19878 |<----------------->|
19879 t t
19880 ---|----|----|----|----|---
19881 | Th Tw Tc Td |
19882 |<------ Tt ------->|
19883
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019884 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019885 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019886 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
19887 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
19888 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019889 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019890 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
19891 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
19892 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
19893 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019894
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019895 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
19896 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
19897 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019898 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
19899 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
19900 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
19901 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
19902 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
19903 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019904
19905 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
19906 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
19907 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
19908 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
19909 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
19910 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
19911 request typed by hand during a test.
19912
19913 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
19914 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019915 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019916 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
19917 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
19918 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
19919 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019920
19921 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
19922 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
19923 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
19924 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
19925 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
19926
19927 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
19928 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
19929 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
19930 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
19931 connection never established.
19932
19933 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
19934 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
19935 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
19936 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
19937 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
19938 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
19939 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
19940 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
19941 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
19942 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
19943 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
19944
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019945 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
19946 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
19947 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
19948 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
19949 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
19950 by subtracting other timers when valid :
19951
19952 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
19953
19954 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
19955 "Ta" can never be negative.
19956
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019957 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
19958 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019959 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
19960 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019961 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019962
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019963 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019964
19965 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019966 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
19967 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019968
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019969 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
19970 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
19971 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
19972 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
19973 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
19974 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
19975 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
19976 prefixed with a '+' sign.
19977
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019978These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
19979protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
19980that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019981due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
19982"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
19983that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019984
19985Most common cases :
19986
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019987 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
19988 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
19989 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
19990 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
19991 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
19992 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
19993 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
19994 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
19995 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
19996 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
19997 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020019998 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019999
20000 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
20001 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
20002 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
20003 of ms on remote networks.
20004
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020005 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
20006 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
20007 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020008
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020009 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
20010 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
20011 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
20012 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
20013 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
20014 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
20015 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
20016 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
20017 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020018
20019Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
20020
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020021 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020022 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020023 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020024
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020025 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020026 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
20027 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
20028
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020029 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020030 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
20031 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
20032 flags.
20033
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020034 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
20035 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020036 Check the session termination flags, then check the
20037 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
20038 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
20039 the client connection was maintained open.
20040
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020041 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020042 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020043 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020044 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
20045
20046
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200478.5. Session state at disconnection
20048-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020049
20050TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
20051"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
200522-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
20053each of which has a special meaning :
20054
20055 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
20056 session to terminate :
20057
20058 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
20059
20060 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
20061 server explicitly refused it.
20062
20063 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
20064 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
20065 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
20066 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020067 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020068
20069 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
20070 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020071
20072 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
20073 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
20074 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
20075 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
20076 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
20077
20078 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
20079 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
20080 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
20081 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
20082 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
20083
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090020084 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
20085 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
20086
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070020087 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
20088 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
20089 backup connections when going up.
20090
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020020091 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
20092
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020093 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
20094 send or receive data.
20095
20096 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
20097 send or receive data.
20098
20099 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
20100 with nothing left in the buffers.
20101
20102 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
20103
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010020104 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020105 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
20106
20107 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
20108 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
20109 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
20110 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
20111 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
20112
20113 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
20114 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
20115
20116 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
20117 server (HTTP only).
20118
20119 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
20120
20121 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
20122 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
20123 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
20124
20125 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
20126 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
20127 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
20128
20129 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
20130
20131 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
20132 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
20133
20134 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
20135 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
20136 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
20137
20138 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
20139 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020020140 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
20141 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020142
20143 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
20144 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
20145 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
20146 another server.
20147
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020148 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020149 server.
20150
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020151 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
20152 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
20153 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
20154 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20155
20156 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
20157 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
20158 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
20159 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20160
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020020161 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
20162 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
20163 "use-server" rule).
20164
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020165 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20166
20167 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
20168 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
20169
20170 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
20171
20172 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
20173 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
20174 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
20175
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020176 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
20177 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020178 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020179 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
20180 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
20181
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020182 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
20183
20184 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
20185 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
20186
20187 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
20188
20189 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20190
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020191The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
20192was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020193helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
20194starvation, attacks, etc...
20195
20196The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
20197alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
20198easier finding and understanding.
20199
20200 Flags Reason
20201
20202 -- Normal termination.
20203
20204 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
20205 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
20206 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
20207 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
20208
20209 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
20210 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
20211 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
20212 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
20213 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
20214 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020215
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020216 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20217 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020218 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020219
20220 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
20221 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
20222 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
20223
20224 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
20225 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
20226 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
20227 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
20228 the server takes too long to respond.
20229
20230 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
20231 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
20232 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
20233 long a time to respond.
20234
20235 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
20236 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
20237 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
20238 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020239 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
20240 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020241
20242 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
20243 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
20244 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
20245 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
20246 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020020247 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020248 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
20249 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
20250 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
20251 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
20252 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
20253 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
20254 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
20255 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020256 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020257 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
20258 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
20259 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020260
20261 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
20262 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020263 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
20264 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
20265 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
20266 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020267
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020268 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
20269 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
20270
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020271 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020272 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
20273 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020274 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020275 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
20276 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
20277
20278 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
20279 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
20280 503 or 504 here.
20281
20282 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
20283 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
20284 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
20285 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
20286 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
20287
20288 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20289 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020290 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020291 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
20292 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
20293
20294 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
20295 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
20296 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
20297 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
20298 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
20299 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
20300 between haproxy and the server.
20301
20302 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
20303 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
20304 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
20305 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
20306 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
20307 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
20308 solution is to fix the application.
20309
20310 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
20311 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
20312 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
20313 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
20314 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
20315 external attacks.
20316
20317 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
20318 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020319 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020320 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
20321 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
20322
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020323 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
20324 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
20325 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020326 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020020327 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020328
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020329 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
20330 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
20331 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
20332 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020333 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
20334 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
20335 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
20336 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
20337 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020338
20339 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
20340 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
20341 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
20342 returned an HTTP 403 error.
20343
20344 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
20345 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
20346 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
20347 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
20348
20349 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
20350 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
20351 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
20352 only be solved by proper system tuning.
20353
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020354The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
20355persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
20356important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
20357re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
20358
20359 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
20360
20361 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20362 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
20363 set on a GET request.
20364
20365 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
20366 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020367 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020368 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
20369
20370 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
20371 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
20372 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
20373
20374 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20375 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
20376 already got a cookie.
20377
20378 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20379 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
20380 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
20381 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
20382 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
20383
20384 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20385 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20386 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20387
20388 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
20389 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20390 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20391
20392 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
20393 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
20394
20395 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
20396 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
20397 then advertised in the response.
20398
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020399
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204008.6. Non-printable characters
20401-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020402
20403In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
20404consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
20405converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
20406prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
20407being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
20408escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
20409is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
20410'}' when logging headers.
20411
20412Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
20413issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
20414containing spaces is "User-Agent".
20415
20416Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
20417the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
20418performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
20419
20420
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204218.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
20422---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020423
20424Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
20425achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020426section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020427cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
20428the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
20429the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020430locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020431not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
20432user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
20433a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
20434wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
20435
20436 Examples :
20437 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
20438 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
20439
20440 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
20441 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
20442
20443
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204448.8. Capturing HTTP headers
20445---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020446
20447Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
20448proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
20449the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
20450server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
20451
20452Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
20453response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020454section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020455
20456It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020457time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
20458appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020459are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
20460and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
20461follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
20462request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
20463in the logs.
20464
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020465As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
20466frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
20467an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
20468
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020469 Example :
20470 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
20471 listen proxy-out
20472 mode http
20473 option httplog
20474 option logasap
20475 log global
20476 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
20477
20478 # log the name of the virtual server
20479 capture request header Host len 20
20480
20481 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
20482 capture request header Content-Length len 10
20483
20484 # log the beginning of the referrer
20485 capture request header Referer len 20
20486
20487 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
20488 capture response header Server len 20
20489
20490 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
20491 capture response header Content-Length len 10
20492
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020493 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020494 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
20495
20496 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
20497 capture response header Via len 20
20498
20499 # log the URL location during a redirection
20500 capture response header Location len 20
20501
20502 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
20503 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
20504 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20505 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
20506 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
20507
20508 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20509 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20510 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20511 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020512 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020513
20514 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20515 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20516 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20517 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
20518 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020519 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020520
20521
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205228.9. Examples of logs
20523---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020524
20525These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
20526them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
20527reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
20528
20529 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
20530 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20531 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20532
20533 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
20534 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
20535
20536 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
20537 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
20538 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20539
20540 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
20541 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
20542
20543 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
20544 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20545 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
20546
20547 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020548 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020549 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
20550 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
20551
20552 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
20553 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
20554 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
20555
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020020556 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
20557 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
20558 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
20559 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
20560 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
20561 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020562
20563 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020564 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020565
20566 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
20567 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
20568 Nothing was sent to any server.
20569
20570 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
20571 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
20572
20573 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
20574 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020575 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020576 send a 408 return code to the client.
20577
20578 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
20579 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
20580
20581 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
20582 5 seconds ("c----").
20583
20584 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
20585 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020586 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020587
20588 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020589 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020590 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
20591 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
20592 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
20593 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
20594 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020595
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020020596
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200205979. Supported filters
20598--------------------
20599
20600Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
20601accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
20602unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
20603
20604See also : "filter"
20605
206069.1. Trace
20607----------
20608
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010020609filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020610
20611 Arguments:
20612 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
20613 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
20614
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010020615 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020616
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020617 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020618 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
20619 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
20620 amount of the parsed data.
20621
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020622 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020623
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020624This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
20625callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
20626information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
20627filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
20628
20629Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
20630tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
20631a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
20632
20633
206349.2. HTTP compression
20635---------------------
20636
20637filter compression
20638
20639The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
20640keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020641when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
20642fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
20643done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
20644explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
20645filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
20646listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20647order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020648
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020649See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
20650 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020651
20652
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200206539.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
20654--------------------------------------------
20655
20656filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
20657
20658 Arguments :
20659
20660 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
20661 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
20662 parsed.
20663
20664 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
20665 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
20666 part must be placed in its own scope.
20667
20668The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
20669external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020670streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020671exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
20672also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
20673
20674SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
20675the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
20676
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020677For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020678"doc/SPOE.txt".
20679
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100206809.4. Cache
20681----------
20682
20683filter cache <name>
20684
20685 Arguments :
20686
20687 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
20688
20689The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
20690"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020691cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020692other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
20693case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
20694is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
20695filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010020696listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20697order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010020698
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020699See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
20700 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
20701
20702
207039.5. Fcgi-app
20704-------------
20705
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020706filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020707
20708 Arguments :
20709
20710 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
20711
20712The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
20713request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
20714reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
20715used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
20716implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
20717used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
20718fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
20719used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20720order.
20721
20722See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
20723 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
20724
20725
2072610. FastCGI applications
20727-------------------------
20728
20729HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
20730feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
20731the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
20732FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
20733servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
20734FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
20735backend.
20736
20737HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
20738application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
20739connection.
20740
2074110.1. Setup
20742-----------
20743
2074410.1.1. Fcgi-app section
20745--------------------------
20746
20747fcgi-app <name>
20748 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
20749 document root must be defined.
20750
20751acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
20752 Declare or complete an access list.
20753
20754 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
20755 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
20756 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
20757 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
20758 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
20759
20760docroot <path>
20761 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
20762 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
20763 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
20764
20765index <script-name>
20766 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
20767 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
20768 is an optional setting.
20769
20770 Example :
20771 index index.php
20772
20773log-stderr global
20774log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
20775 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
20776 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
20777
20778 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
20779 default STDERR messages are ignored.
20780
20781pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20782 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
20783 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
20784 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20785
20786 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
20787 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
20788 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
20789 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
20790
20791 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
20792 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
20793
20794path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020795 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020796 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
20797 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
20798 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
20799 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
20800 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
20801 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
20802 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020803
20804 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020805 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020806 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
20807 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
20808 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
20809 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020810
20811 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020812 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
20813 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020814
20815option get-values
20816no option get-values
20817 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
20818
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020819 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020820 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
20821
20822 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
20823 application will accept.
20824
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020020825 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
20826 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020827
20828 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050020829 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020830 option is disabled.
20831
20832 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
20833 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
20834 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
20835 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
20836 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
20837 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
20838
20839option keep-conn
20840no option keep-conn
20841 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
20842 sending a response.
20843
20844 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
20845 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
20846
20847option max-reqs <reqs>
20848 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
20849 accept.
20850
20851 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
20852 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
20853 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
20854 to 1.
20855
20856option mpxs-conns
20857no option mpxs-conns
20858 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
20859
20860 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
20861 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
20862
20863set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20864 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
20865 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
20866 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
20867 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20868
20869 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
20870 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
20871 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
20872
20873 Example :
20874 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
20875 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
20876
20877 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
20878
20879
2088010.1.2. Proxy section
20881---------------------
20882
20883use-fcgi-app <name>
20884 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
20885
20886 Arguments :
20887 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
20888
20889 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
20890 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
20891 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
20892 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
20893 application may be defined at a time per backend.
20894
20895 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
20896 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
20897 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
20898 application are evaluated.
20899
20900
2090110.1.3. Example
20902---------------
20903
20904 frontend front-http
20905 mode http
20906 bind *:80
20907 bind *:
20908
20909 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
20910 default_backend back-static
20911
20912 backend back-static
20913 mode http
20914 server www A.B.C.D:80
20915
20916 backend back-dynamic
20917 mode http
20918 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
20919 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
20920
20921 fcgi-app php-fpm
20922 log-stderr global
20923 option keep-conn
20924
20925 docroot /var/www/my-app
20926 index index.php
20927 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
20928
20929
2093010.2. Default parameters
20931------------------------
20932
20933A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
20934the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020935script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020936applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
20937
20938 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20939 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
20940 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
20941 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
20942 | | |
20943 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20944 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
20945 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
20946 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
20947 | | application. |
20948 | | |
20949 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20950 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
20951 | | the request. It may not be set. |
20952 | | |
20953 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20954 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
20955 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
20956 | | the application's configuration. |
20957 | | |
20958 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20959 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
20960 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
20961 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
20962 | | |
20963 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20964 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
20965 | | following the part that identifies the script |
20966 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
20967 | | be defined. |
20968 | | |
20969 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20970 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
20971 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
20972 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
20973 | | is not set too. |
20974 | | |
20975 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20976 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
20977 | | set. |
20978 | | |
20979 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20980 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
20981 | | the request. |
20982 | | |
20983 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20984 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
20985 | | client as part of user authentication. |
20986 | | |
20987 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20988 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
20989 | | script to process the request. |
20990 | | |
20991 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20992 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
20993 | | |
20994 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20995 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
20996 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
20997 | | |
20998 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20999 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
21000 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
21001 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
21002 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
21003 | | |
21004 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21005 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
21006 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
21007 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
21008 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
21009 | | side. |
21010 | | |
21011 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21012 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
21013 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
21014 | | connected to. |
21015 | | |
21016 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21017 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
21018 | | |
21019 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21020 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
21021 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
21022 | | |
21023 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21024
21025
2102610.3. Limitations
21027------------------
21028
21029The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
21030way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
21031during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
21032establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
21033application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
21034or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
21035message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
21036these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
21037and HTTP servers under the same backend.
21038
21039Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
21040request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
21041requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
21042
21043About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
21044into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
21045fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
21046"http-request" ones.
21047
21048Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
21049FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
21050processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
21051must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
21052here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010021053
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021054/*
21055 * Local variables:
21056 * fill-column: 79
21057 * End:
21058 */